Terms in this Guide
Concepts
Define - Used when referring to the definition in the OEMConfig schema that determines what the administrator is permitted to do as opposed to what an admin might elect to do. For example, within a Step, an admin is permitted to include one of every defined Managed Configuration Group but in most cases would only elect to include only one or a few.
Include - Used when referring to a decision by an administrator to elect to perform some Action or configuration as opposed to what the administrator is permitted to do, but may or may not elect to do. For example, an admin would be permitted to include one of everything, but likely would elect to include only one or a few.
Instance - A SINGLE occurrence or use of something (such as a Step, MC, Group, Sub-group, or Sub-array). An Instance might refer to the inclusion of a Step in a Transaction; an MC or Group in a Step; an MC, Sub-group, or Sub-array in a Group; or a Sub-group as an element of a Sub-array.
Elements
Transaction - An ordered list of Steps, each of which specifies one or more Actions to be performed or settings to be configured on a Zebra device. Steps are executed in the exact order specified within the Transaction, but the order of execution within a Step is controlled by the system. The recommended means of controlling the order of execution, if required, is to use separate Steps within a Transaction.
Step - A collection of Actions to be performed or settings to be configured at a specific point within a Transaction. Within a Step, some MCs are defined directly (such as for entering an Explanation or selecting an Error Mode), but most are organized into Managed Configuration Groups. An instance of a Step can include no more than one instance of any MC or Group that is defined for a Step. Within a Step, all included MCs and Groups, and anything included within any Groups, are executed in an order determined by the system to afford the greatest likelihood of success. For example, the system might execute a Bluetooth configuration after an Action to enable Bluetooth because configuring Bluetooth might fail if attempted when Bluetooth was disabled.
Group - See Managed Configuration Group.
Managed Configuration Group - A collection of MCs, Sub-groups, or Sub-arrays that are defined to control some aspect of the device (such as Analytics Configuration or Audio Configuration). A Group can include no more than one instance of any MC, Sub-group, or Sub-array that is defined for that Group.
Sub-group - A collection of MCs, Sub-groups, or Sub-arrays that are defined as permitted to control some sub-aspect of the device (such as Send to Cloud Detail in Bug Reporting Configuration). A Sub-group can include no more than one instance of any MC, Sub-group, or Sub-array defined for that Sub-group.
Sub-array - An ordered list of instances of a SINGLE Sub-group, each of which can contain anything that is defined for that Sub-group. The only time the same MC, Sub-group, or Sub-array can be included more than once into the same Step is when it appears within different elements of a Sub-array. For example, the Key Mapping Configuration Group defines a Sub-array Add Mapping Behaviors that can be used to configure multiple behaviors for a single key in different modifier states (orange, green, blue, etc.). A single Step can include multiple instances of the MCs defined for the Behaviors Sub-group, by including them in different elements in the Add Mapping Behaviors Sub-array.
Type Styling
- Bold Italic type indicates values of a Managed Configuration such as On or Enable.
- Bold type indicates the name of an MC, Group, Sub-group, or Sub-array, such as the Audio Configuration Group or the State Managed Configuration.
- Italic type indicates defined terms, such as Transaction and Step.
NOTE: Defined terms are Capitalized to differentiate from italics used for emphasis.
Transaction Overview
This section of the OEMConfig documentation describes all supported Managed Configurations (MCs), which can be used to define an ordered list of Steps for defining one or more Actions to be performed or settings to be configured on a Zebra device as part of an overall Transaction. Before attempting to configure a Transaction, it's important to understand the concept of Managed Configuration Groups, Sub-groups, Sub-arrays. A Transaction can contain one or many of these elements, and can be nested multiple levels deep.
Analytics Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure State and User Control of State.
Detail Information:
Key = analyticsStep
Type = bundle
State
Select whether the Analytics Client on a device is turned on (enabled) or turned off (disabled).
The Analytics Client is turned on (enabled) by default on all devices:
- If the value Off is selected, the Analytics Client will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not collect any machine data during the operation of the device and will not deliver any machine data regardless of whether connectivity is available.
- If the value On is selected, the Analytics Client will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will automatically collect machine data during the operation of the device and deliver it, when connectivity is available, to the Zebra Analytics Cloud Server.
On some devices, the ability to turn off (disable) the Analytics Client may not be supported.
Detail Information:
Key = analyticsState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.3.
User Control of State
Select whether the the device user will be allowed to control whether the Analytics Client on a device is turned on (enabled) or turned off (disabled).
The Analytics Client is turned on (enabled) by default on all devices:
- If the value Off is selected, the device user will not be allowed to change whether the Analytics Client is turned off (disabled) or on (enabled), and hence whether it will collect or deliver any machine data during the operation of the device.
- If the value On is selected, the device user will be allowed to change whether the Analytics Client is turned off (disabled) or on (enabled), and hence whether it will collect or deliver any machine data during the operation of the device.
Detail Information:
Key = analyticsUserControlState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.2.
App Feature Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure App Feature State, App Feature Name, and App Feature Package Name .
Detail Information:
Key = appFeatureStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Pie and Oreo.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
App Feature State
Select whether a specified Application Feature should be On or Off.
- If the value Off is selected, the Application Feature will be turned Off.
- If the value On is selected, the Application Feature will be turned On.
You must also specify App Feature Name to provide the Feature Name that identifies the Application Feature to be turned On or Off and App Feature Package Name to specify the Android Package Name that identifies the application for which the Application Feature will be turned On or Off.
Detail Information:
Key = appFeatureState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Pie and Oreo.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
App Feature Name
Select the Feature Name that identifies the application for which an Application Feature will be turned On or Off when App Feature State is specified. You must also specify App Feature Package Name to identify the application for which the specified Application Feature will be turned On or Off.
Detail Information:
Key = appFeatureName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Background Data | 1 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Pie and Oreo.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
App Feature Package Name
Select the Android Package Name that identifies the application for which an Application Feature will be turned On or Off when App Feature State is specified. You must also specify App Feature Name to specify the Feature Name that identifies the Application Feature that will be turned On or Off for the specified application.
Detail Information:
Key = appFeaturePackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Pie and Oreo.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
AppGallery Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure State, Push Notifications, Credential Type, Custom User Name, Custom Password, and Custom Organization Key.
Detail Information:
Key = appgalleryStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Support discontinued from: MX 9.2.
State
This Managed Configuration is deprecated and will be discontinued in a subsequent version.
Detail Information:
Key = appgalleryState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | false |
On | true |
Support Information:
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Support discontinued from: MX 9.2.
Push Notifications
This Managed Configuration is deprecated and will be discontinued in a subsequent version.
Detail Information:
Key = appgalleryPushNotifications
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | false |
On | true |
Support Information:
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Support discontinued from: MX 9.2.
Credential Type
This Managed Configuration is deprecated and will be discontinued in a subsequent version.
Detail Information:
Key = appgalleryCredentialType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Default | true |
Custom | false |
Support Information:
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Support discontinued from: MX 9.2.
Custom User Name
This Managed Configuration is deprecated and will be discontinued in a subsequent version.
Detail Information:
Key = appgalleryCredentialTypeCustomUserName
Type = string
Support Information:
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Support discontinued from: MX 9.2.
Custom Password
This Managed Configuration is deprecated and will be discontinued in a subsequent version.
Detail Information:
Key = appgalleryCredentialTypeCustomPassword
Type = string
Support Information:
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Support discontinued from: MX 9.2.
Custom Organization Key
This Managed Configuration is deprecated and will be discontinued in a subsequent version.
Detail Information:
Key = appgalleryCredentialTypeCustomOrganizationKey
Type = string
Support Information:
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Support discontinued from: MX 9.2.
Audio Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Allow device user Control Vibrate On Call, Best Path Exclude Action, Best Path Exclude Device, Control Vibrate On Call Options, Play AC Detect Sound, Replication Action, and Mute/Vibrate.
Detail Information:
Key = audioStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.2.
Allow device user Control Vibrate On Call
Select whether the device user can change the state of vibrate on call
If the value Enable is selected, the device user will be able to change the state of vibrate on call options.
If the value Disable is selected, the device user will not be able to change the state of vibrate on call options.
Detail Information:
Key = audioUserContolVibrateForCalls
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Enable | 1 |
Disable | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.1.
Best Path Exclude Action
Select whether to add, remove, or remove all audio paths from the list of paths to exclude from best path consideration when the device is docked.
If the value Add Device is selected, the audio path selected in Best Path Exclude Device will be added to the list.
If the value Remove Device is selected, the audio path selected in Best Path Exclude Device will be removed from the list.
If the value Remove All Devices is selected, all audio paths will be removed the list. <<<
Detail Information:
Key = audioBestPathExcludeAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Add Device | 1 |
Remove Device | 2 |
Remove All Devices | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.3.
Best Path Exclude Device
Select the audio path on which the best path exclude action is to be taken when the device is docked.
Detail Information:
Key = audioBestPathExcludeDevice
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Wired Headset (3.5 mm) | 2 |
USB Audio | 3 |
Bluetooth A2DP Audio | 4 |
HDMI Audio | 5 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.3.
Control Vibrate On Call Options
Select whether the device user can change the state of vibrate on call
If the value Never Vibrate is selected, the device will never vibrate for incoming calls.
If the value Always Vibrate is selected, the device will always vibrate for incoming calls.
if the value Vibrate First Then Ring Gradually is selected, the device will vibrate first and then the ringer will gradually increase in volume.
Detail Information:
Key = audioSetVibrateOnCallsOption
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Never Vibrate | 1 |
Always Vibrate | 2 |
Vibrate First Then Ring Gradually | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.1.
Play AC Detect Sound
Select whether a notification sound will be played when the device is connected to AC power.
- If the value Off is selected, no sound will be played when AC power is connected.
- If the value On is selected, a chime will play when AC power is connected.
Detail Information:
Key = audioPlayACConnectChime
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
Replication Action
Select the audio replication behavior of of a device.
If the value Replicate headset audio on built-in speaker is selected, audio routed to the headset will also be routed to the built-in speaker. This might be desirable in a situation where the device user may walk away from a vehicle mounted device and leave his headset in the vehicle while performing some task nearby. If an audible alert is also routed to the built-in speaker, the device user might still hear it.
If the value Do not replicate headset audio on built-in speaker is selected, audio routed to the headset will also be routed to the built-in speaker. This might be desirable in a situation where the device is being used in an area where routing audio to the built-in speaker could be disruptive to others in the area.
Detail Information:
Key = audioReplicationAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Replicate headset audio on built-in speaker | 1 |
Do not replicate headset audio on built-in speaker | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.2.
Mute/Vibrate
Select the mute and vibrate behavior of a device.
If the value Mute without Vibrate is selected, the volume will be muted (made silent) and the device will NOT vibrate, permitting neither audible nor tactile alerts.
If the value Mute with Vibrate is selected, the volume will be muted (made silent) and the device will vibrate, permitting tactile but NOT audible alerts.
If the value Unmute without Vibrate is selected, the volume will be unmuted (made audible) and the device will NOT vibrate, permitting audible but not tactile alerts.
Detail Information:
Key = audioStepMuteVibrate
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Mute without Vibrate | 1 |
Mute with Vibrate | 2 |
Unmute without Vibrate | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Auto Trigger Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure State and Range
Automatic triggering allows a device user to initiate trigger-activated functions simply by bringing an object within proximity of the device sensor as opposed to requiring the device user to manually initiate such functions.
Detail Information:
Key = autoTriggerStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
State
Select whether and how automatic triggering should occur on a device.
If the value Off is selected, automatic triggering will never occur and the device user will be required to manually initiate trigger-activated functions.
If the value Auto On is selected, automatic triggering may occur automatically if the device is placed into a suitable holster, holder, or stand allowing the device user to initiate trigger-activated functions simply by bringing an object within proximity to the device sensor.
If the value Always On is selected, automatic triggering can always occur automatically , whether the device is placed into a suitable holster, holder, or stand allowing the device user to initiate trigger-activated functions simply by bringing an object within proximity to the device sensor.
Detail Information:
Key = autoTriggerState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
Auto On | 1 |
Always On | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Range
Select the range at which automatic triggering will detect the presence of an object and initiate automatic triggering.
If the value Near is selected, automatic triggering will occur only when an object is brought within near proximity to the device sensor. This may be desirable if the device is being worn in a holster and hence it is convenient to bring objects very close to the device sensor.
If the value Far is selected, automatic triggering will occur when an object is brought within less near proximity to the device sensor. This may be desirable if the device is located in a stand or holder and hence it is less convenient to have to bring objects very close to the device sensor.
Detail Information:
Key = autoTriggerRange
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Near | 0 |
Far | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Blacklist Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Action, Allow System Package Name, and Disallow System Package Name
Blacklisting applies only to System applications, which are applications built into the device and are therefore always present. It has no effect on user applications, which are installed during staging or at some time after the device is put into service and DO NOT come preinstalled on the device. User apps are controlled using the Whitelist Configuration Group.
WARNING: It is important to understand that an app COULD use the Blacklist Configuration Group to blacklist itself. If an app is blacklisted, then it is prevented from running once the Blacklist Configuration is successfully applied, even if the app being blacklisted was the app that requested the blacklisting to be performed.
Detail Information:
Key = blacklistStep
Type = bundle
Action
Select an Action to enable or disable a single built-in System Application on a device.
All built-in System Applications are enabled by default on devices.
Allowing a built-in System Application allows it to be freely launched, either by the device user or programmatically by other Applications.
Disallowing a built-in System Application prevents it from being launched, either by the device user or programmatically by other Applications.
Since a built-in System Application is built-in, you cannot uninstall it from a device, even if you do not wish it to be used.
To prevent the use of a built-in System Application, you can disable it and thereby prevent its use, even though it remains installed.
- If the value Allow is selected, you must also specify Allow System Package Name to provide the Android Package Name that identifies the Built-In System Application to be allowed.
- If the value Disallow is selected, you must also specify Disallow System Package Name to provide the Android Package Name that identifies the Built-In System Application to be disallowed.
Detail Information:
Key = blacklistAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | DisableApplication |
Allow | EnableApplication |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Allow System Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name that identifies a Built-In System Application to be allowed when the Action value Allow is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = blacklistActionAllowSystemPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Disallow System Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name that identifies a Built-In System Application to be disallowed when the Action value Disallow is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = blacklistActionDisallowSystemPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Bluetooth Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Beacon, Discoverability, New Pairings, Paired Device Action, Turn On/Off Silent Pairing, Turn On/Off Single Pairing Category, Action, Add Rule Name, Add Rule MAC Address, Add Rule Device Class, Add Rule Device Upper Address Part, Add Rule Pairing PIN Code, Remove Rule Name, Remove Rule MAC Address, Remove Rule Device Class, Remove Rule Device Upper Address Part, Remove Rule Pairing PIN Code, and BLE.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.1.
Beacon Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure State, Airplane Mode State, Beaconing On Battery Reinsert, Type, Explicit Beacon UUID, AltBeacon, Custom Beacon, Custom Transmit Power Level, Transmit Power Level, Custom Transmit Interval, and Transmit Interval.
Detail Information:
Key = btBeaconConfig
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
State
Select whether a beacon will be emitted (on) or not (off) while the device display is turned off.
- If the value Off is selected, a beacon will NOT be emitted when the device display is turned off.
- If the value On is selected, a beacon WILL be emitted when the device display is turned off.
Detail Information:
Key = btBeaconState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Airplane Mode State
Select whether the emitting of Beacons while the Device is Powered Off will be conditioned based on whether Airplane Mode was On at the time the Device was powered Off.
This is only relevant when On is specified for State.
Detail Information:
Key = btBeaconAirplaneModeState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Beaconing On Battery Reinsert
Select whether to emit beacon upon battery reinsertion while device is still powered off. By default, beacon will be emitted.
This is only relevant when On is specified for State.
Detail Information:
Key = btBeaconingOnBatteryReinsert
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Type
Select the Type of Beacon to be emitted.
- If the value AltBeacon is selected, an AltBeacon style Beacon will be emitted. If On is specified for Explicit Beacon UUID, then UUID must also be specified.
- If the value Custom is selected, a Custom style Beach will be emitted and Data must also be specified to define the Custom Beacon style.
Detail Information:
Key = btBeaconType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
AltBeacon | 2 |
Custom | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Explicit Beacon UUID
Select whether an explicit UUID will be used for the beacon when AltBeacon is specified for Type.
Detail Information:
Key = btExplicitBeaconUUID
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
AltBeacon Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure UUID, ID1, ID2, Manufacturing Byte, and Reference RSSI.
Detail Information:
Key = btAltBeaconConfig
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
UUID
Enter the UUID to use when AltBeacon is specified for Type and On is specified for Explicit Beacon UUID.
Detail Information:
Key = btAltBeaconUUID
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
ID1
Enter the 4 hexadecimal characters to use for ID1 when AltBeacon is specified for Type. If no value is entered, the default value of EBEB will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = btAltBeaconID1
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
ID2
Enter the 4 hexadecimal characters to use for ID2 when AltBeacon is specified for Type. If no value is entered, the default value of EBEB will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = btAltBeaconID2
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Manufacturing Byte
Enter the 2 hexadecimal characters to use for the manufacturing byte when AltBeacon is specified for Type. If no value is entered, the default value of 00 will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = btAltBeaconMfgByte
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Reference RSSI
Enter the 2 hexadecimal characters to used for the reference RSSI when AltBeacon is specified for Type. If no value is entered, a calculated value will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = btAltBeaconRefRSSI
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Custom Beacon Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Data.
Detail Information:
Key = btCustomBeaconConfig
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Data
Enter the custom UUID/URL/DATA to use for the custom beacon type. Up to 56 hexadecimal characters that follow the Bluetooth SIG Advertising format may be used when Custom is specified for Type.
Detail Information:
Key = btCustomBeaconData
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Custom Transmit Power Level
Enter the power level (in dBm) of the beacons that will be sent while the device is powered off. Valid range is between -127 and 1.
Detail Information:
Key = btCustomBeaconXmitPower
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Transmit Power Level
Select the Power Level of the beacon that will be emitted while the device is powered off. If not selected, default value will be used (default values vary by device)
- If High (1dBm) is selected, the transmit power level of the beacon will be set to 1dBm (maximum power)
- If Medium (-7dBm) is selected, the transmit power level of the beacon will be set to -7dBm.
- If Low Power (-15dBm) is selected, the transmit power level of the beacon will be set to -15dBm
- If Ultra Low Power(-21dBm) is selected, the transmit power level of the beacon will be set to -21dBm
- If Custom is selected a value between -127 and +1 (dBm) must be entered for Transmit Power Level
Detail Information:
Key = btBeaconXmitPower
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
High (1dBm) | 1 |
Medium (-7dBm) | 2 |
Low Power (-15dBm) | 3 |
Ultra Low Power(-21dBm) | 4 |
Custom | 5 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Custom Transmit Interval
Enter the Interval between beacons that will be sent while the device is powered off. The valid range of values is between 100 and 10240 msec.
Detail Information:
Key = btCustomBeaconXmitInterval
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Transmit Interval
Select the Interval between beacons that will be sent while the device is powered off. If not selected, default value will be used (default values vary by device)
- If Low Latency (100 ms) is selected, the transmit interval between beacons will be set to 100msec (Low Latency)
- If Balanced (250 ms) is selected, the transmit interval between beacons will be set to 250msec (Balanced)
- If Low Power (1000 ms) is selected, the transmit interval between beacons will be set to 1000msec (Low Power)
- If Custom is selected, the transmit interval between beacons will be set to the value specified in Transmit Interval
Detail Information:
Key = btBeaconXmitInterval
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Low Latency (100 ms) | 1 |
Balanced (250 ms) | 2 |
Low Power (1000 ms) | 3 |
Custom | 4 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Discoverability
Select whether the device is Discoverable via Bluetooth.
Devices are NOT Discoverable via Bluetooth by default except when the Bluetooth Pairing screen of the Settings UI is active.
- If the value Off is selected, the default behavior will be in effect and the device will not be Discoverable via Bluetooth except when the Bluetooth Pairing screen of the Settings UI is active.
- If the value On is selected, the default behavior will be overridden and the device will be Discoverable via Bluetooth whenever Bluetooth is enabled (turned on).
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothDiscoverability
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
New Pairings
Enter whether the device will accept new Bluetooth Pairings.
devices will accept new Bluetooth Pairings by default.
- If the value Disallow is selected, the default behavior will be overridden and the device will not accept new Bluetooth Pairings.
- If the value Allow is selected, the default behavior will be in effect and the device will accept new Bluetooth Pairings.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothNewPairings
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.1.
Paired Device Action
Select whether the device will clear all paired devices.
- If the value Do Not Clear All Paired Devices is selected, the no pairings will be cleared.
- If the value Clear All Paired Devices is selected, all existing pairings will be cleared.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothPairedDeviceAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do Not Clear All Paired Devices | 0 |
Clear All Paired Devices | 1 |
Support Information:
- NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Turn On/Off Silent Pairing
Select whether the device can silently perform Bluetooth pairings
Devices will silently perform Bluetooth Pairings by default.
- If the value Disallow is selected, the default behavior will be overridden and the device can not silently perform Bluetooth Pairings.
- If the value Allow is selected, the default behavior will be in effect and the device can silently perform Bluetooth Pairings.
Note that even when the device CAN silently perform Bluetooth Pairings, it WILL NOT do so unless Action is used to configure specific silent pairing rules that define how silent pairing should occur.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothSilentPairingsState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Allow | 2 |
Disallow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Turn On/Off Single Pairing Category
Select the category of device of which only a single pairing will be allowed.
Only one device of the specified category will be permitted to pair.
- If the value Headset is selected, only one Bluetooth headset will be permitted to pair at a time.
- If the value Scanner is selected, only one Bluetooth scanner will be permitted to pair at a time.
- If the value Printer is selected, only one Bluetooth printer will be permitted to pair at a time.
- If the value Payment is selected, only one Bluetooth payment will be permitted to pair at a time.
- If the value Dex is selected, only one Bluetooth Dex will be permitted to pair at a time.
Note that even when the device IS configured to permit only single Bluetooth Pairings, it WILL NOT do so unless Action is used to configure specific silent pairing rules that define how single pairing should occur.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothSinglePairingsCategory
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Headset | 1 |
Scanner | 2 |
Printer | 3 |
Payment | 4 |
Dex | 5 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Action
Select an Action to manage a list of rules that control Bluetooth Silent Pairing.
Bluetooth Silent Pairing allows new Bluetooth Pairings to be automatically completed without device user interaction, if permitted by defined rules. By defining the right set of rules, you can allow pairings between certain types of peripheral devices and a device happen automatically. By automatically is meant that if a pairing is established by an application running on a device, or at the request of a peripheral device, that pairing can complete without device user approval or interaction.
Since the list of rules is empty by default on devices, Bluetooth Silent Pairing is disabled by default, hence all new Bluetooth Pairings will occur manually and thus will require device user interaction to complete . Once one or more rules are added, new pairings to selected peripheral devices identified by these rules will be allowed to occur automatically while all new other new pairings will continue to occur manually.
- If the value AddRule is selected:
- You must also specify Add Rule Name, to provide the name of the new rule to be added or Add Rule MAC Address, to provide the Bluetooth MAC Address of the new rule to be added.
- You must also specify Add Rule Device Class or Add Rule Device Upper Address Part to provide the criteria that the new rule will use to determine which new Bluetooth Pairings will be allowed.
- If the value RemoveRule is selected, you must specify at least one of the following to provide the information that will be used to determine which rule or rules, which have matching information, will be removed:
- Remove Rule Name, to provide the name of the existing rule to be removed or Remove Rule MAC Address to provide the Bluetooth MAC Address of the existing rule to be removed
- Remove Rule Device Class
- Remove Rule Device Upper Address Part
- If the value RemoveAllRules is selected, you do not need to specify any additional information.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
AddRule | 1 |
RemoveRule | 2 |
RemoveAllRules | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Add Rule Name
Enter a name for a new rule to be added to the list of rules that control the operation of Bluetooth Silent Pairing when the Action value AddRule is selected for Action.
Note that you can specify Add Rule Name or Add Rule MAC Address, but not both.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothActionAddRuleName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Add Rule MAC Address
Enter the Bluetooth MAC Address XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX for a new rule to be added from the list of rules that control the operation of Bluetooth Silent Pairing when the Action value AddRule is selected for Action.
Note that you can specify Add Rule Name or Add Rule MAC Address, but not both.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothActionAddRuleMACAddress
Type = string
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Pie.
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
Add Rule Device Class
Enter the Device Class for a new rule to be added to the list of rules that control the operation of Bluetooth Silent Pairing when the Action value AddRule is selected for Action.
When a Device Class is specified for a rule, Bluetooth Silent Pairing will automatically complete new Bluetooth Pairings for Bluetooth devices that have the specified Device Class.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothActionAddRuleDeviceClass
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Add Rule Device Upper Address Part
Enter the Device Upper Address Part for a new rule to be added to the list of rules that control the operation of Bluetooth Silent Pairing when the Action value AddRule is selected for Action.
When a Device Upper Address Part is specified for a rule, Bluetooth Silent Pairing will automatically complete new Bluetooth Pairings for Bluetooth devices that have the specified Device Upper Address Part in the upper part of their Bluetooth Address.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothActionAddRuleUpperAddressPart
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Add Rule Pairing PIN Code
Enter the Pairing PIN Code for a new rule to be added to the list of rules that control the operation of Bluetooth Silent Pairing when the Action value AddRule is selected for Action.
When a Pairing PIN Code is specified for a rule, and the device has a Bluetooth version prior to 2.1, Bluetooth Silent Pairing will automatically use the specified Pairing PIN Code to complete Bluetooth Silent Pairings enabled by the Silent Pairing Rule.
When the device has a Bluetooth version 2.1 or later, a Pairing PIN Code is not required to complete Bluetooth Silent Pairings enabled by the Silent Pairing Rule.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothActionAddRulePIN
Type = string
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Pie.
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
Remove Rule Name
Enter the name that identifies an existing rule to be removed from the list of rules that control the operation of Bluetooth Silent Pairing when the Action value RemoveRule is selected for Action.
Any existing rule that has the specified name will be removed.
Note that you can specify Remove Rule Name or Remove Rule MAC Address, but not both.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothActionRemoveRuleName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Remove Rule MAC Address
Enter the Bluetooth MAC Address XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX that identifies an existing rule to be removed from the list of rules that control the operation of Bluetooth Silent Pairing when the Action value RemoveRule is selected for Action.
Any existing rule that has the specified Bluetooth MAC Address will be removed.
Note that you can specify Remove Rule Name or Remove Rule MAC Address, but not both.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothActionRemoveRuleMACAddress
Type = string
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Pie.
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
Remove Rule Device Class
Enter the Device Class of an existing rule to be removed from the list of rules that control the operation of Bluetooth Silent Pairing when the Action value RemoveRule is selected for Action
Any existing rule or rules that have the specified Device Class will be removed.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothActionRemoveRuleDeviceClass
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Remove Rule Device Upper Address Part
Enter the Device Upper Address Part of an existing rule to be removed from the list of rules that control the operation of Bluetooth Silent Pairing when the Action value RemoveRule is selected for Action.
Any existing rule or rules that have the specified Device Upper Address Part will be removed.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothActionRemoveRuleUpperAddressPart
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Remove Rule Pairing PIN Code
Enter the Pairing PIN Code if remote device is prior to BT 2.1, This Feature is available from Android P onward.
Detail Information:
Key = bluetoothActionRemoveRulePIN
Type = string
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Pie.
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
BLE Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Channel Action, Channel Rule, Channel Rule BLE Channel Blocking, and Channel Rule RF Blocking.
Detail Information:
Key = bleConfig
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Channel Action
:broken_heart: CONTENT-TBD
Detail Information:
Key = bleChannelAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Add Rule | 1 |
Remove All Rules | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.1.
Channel Rule
:broken_heart: CONTENT-TBD
Detail Information:
Key = bleChannelRule
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Block BLE Channels | 0 |
Block RF-Band Based BLE Channels | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.1.
Channel Rule BLE Channel Blocking
:broken_heart: CONTENT-TBD
Detail Information:
Key = bleBLEChannelBlocking
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.1.
Channel Rule RF Blocking
:broken_heart: CONTENT-TBD
Detail Information:
Key = bleRFBlocking
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.1.
Bug Reporting Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Extensions State, Intent Enable, Screenshot Enable, Show In Power Key Menu, ANR Error Action, Unexpected Error Action, Send to Cloud Detail, Store in Device Detail, Send Via Email Detail, Dialog Elements, and Dialog Time Out.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Extensions State
Select whether the Standard Android or Zebra Extended Bug Reporting should be used for generation of Bug Reports from a device.
- If the value Off is selected, Standard Android Bug Reporting will be used, with no Zebra Extensions or Enhancements.
- If the value On is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting. You may also need to specify additional configuration with the Group to configure the desired behavior and options of Zebra Extended Bug Reporting.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportBugReportProfile
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | old |
On | new |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Intent Enable
Select whether the Zebra Extended Bug Reporting should allow a Bug Report to be initiated by an application by sending a broadcast intent with an action value of com.symbol.mxmf.intent.START_FOR_BUG_REPORT. This is meaningful only when Zebra Extended Bug Reporting is enabled.
- If the value Off is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting, if enabled, will not initiate a Bug Report when the defined intent is received.
- If the value On is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting, if enabled, will initiate a Bug Report when the defined intent is received.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportEnableIntent
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | False |
On | True |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Screenshot Enable
Select whether the Zebra Extended Bug Reporting should be allowed to capture screenshots and attach them to Bug Reports.
- If the value Off is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting, if enabled, will not capture Bug Reports nor attach them to Bug Reports.
- If the value On is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting, if enabled, will capture Bug Reports and attach them to Bug Reports.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportEnableScreenshot
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | False |
On | True |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Show In Power Key Menu
Select whether Zebra Extended Bug Reporting should display an option to initiate a Bug Report in the menu which appears after long-pressing the power key on the device.
- If the value Off is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will NOT add an option to the menu.
- If the value On is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting, will add an option to the menu.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportEnableBRInPwrMenu
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | False |
On | True |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
ANR Error Action
Select whether Zebra Extended Bug Reporting should watch for the occurrence of Application Not Responding (ANR) errors and take action when they are detected.
- If the value Do not capture is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will NOT watch for the occurrence of ANR errors, and hence will take no action if they occur.
- If the value Capture bug report is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will watch for the occurrence of ANR errors, and will automatically initiate a Bug Report each time it detects that one has occurred.
- If the value Capture logcat log is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will watch for the occurrence of ANR errors, and will automatically initiate a Logcat capture each time it detects that one has occurred.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportANRErrAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do not capture | NoCapture |
Capture bug report | CaptureBR |
Capture logcat log | CaptureLogcat |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Unexpected Error Action
Select whether Zebra Extended Bug Reporting should watch for the occurrence of Unexpected Application Errors (UAEs) and take action when they are detected.
- If the value Do not capture is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will NOT watch for the occurrence of UAEs, and hence will take no action if they occur.
- If the value Capture bug report is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will watch for the occurrence of UAEs, and will automatically initiate a Bug Report each time it detects that one has occurred.
- If the value Capture logcat log is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will watch for the occurrence of UAEs, and will automatically initiate a Logcat capture each time it detects that one has occurred.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportUnexpectedErrAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do not capture | NoCapture |
Capture bug report | CaptureBR |
Capture logcat log | CaptureLogcat |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Send to Cloud Detail
Use this Sub-group to configure State and Time to Live.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportCloudDetails
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
State
Select whether Zebra Extended Bug Reporting should automatically send copies of generated Bug Reports to the Zebra Cloud Server.
- If the value Off is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will NOT send copies of generated Bug Reports to the Zebra Cloud Server.
- If the value On is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting, if enabled, will send copies of all generated Bug Reports to the Zebra Cloud Server.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportCloudEnable
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | False |
On | True |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Time to Live
Select a timeout value, the expiration of which will cause the sending Bug Reports to the Zebra Cloud Server to automatically cease.
- If the value Never Expire is selected, and Zebra Extended Bug Reporting is configured to send Bug Reports to the Zebra Cloud Server via the Group Send to Cloud Detail, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will continue to send Bug Reports to the Zebra Cloud Server, until the configuration is explicitly changed again.
- If any other value is selected, at the time Zebra Extended Bug Reporting is configured to send Bug Reports to the Zebra Cloud Server via the Group Send to Cloud Detail, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will start a timer from the specified timeout value and will cease sending Bug Reports to the Zebra Cloud Server when the timer expires, until the configuration is explicitly changed again.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportCloudTTL
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Never Expire | 0 |
1 Day | 1 |
1 Week | 7 |
2 Weeks | 14 |
1 Month | 30 |
3 Months | 90 |
6 Months | 180 |
1 Year | 365 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Store in Device Detail
Use this Sub-group to configure State, File Path, and Time to Live.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportStorageDetails
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
State
Select whether Zebra Extended Bug Reporting should automatically store copies of generated Bug Reports in the device.
- If the value Off is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will NOT store copies of generated Bug Reports in the device.
- If the value On is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting, if enabled, will store copies of generated Bug Reports in the device.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportStorageEnable
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | False |
On | True |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
File Path
Enter the path where Zebra Extended Bug Reporting should automatically store copies of generated Bug Reports in the device when the value On is selected for State.
Note that either fixed or removable storage are supported, but the specified path must be valid at the time Bug Report is generated. If no path is specified, bug reports are stored in /storage/sdcard0/BugReports/, which will always be a valid path for storage of Bug Reports on all devices.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportBugReportFilePath
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Time to Live
Select a timeout value, the expiration of which will cause the storing of Bug Reports in the device to automatically cease.
- If the value Never Expire is selected, and when Zebra Extended Bug Reporting is configured to store Bug Reports in the device via the Group Store in Device Detail, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will continue to store Bug Reports in the device until the configuration is explicitly changed again.
- If any other value is selected, at the time Zebra Extended Bug Reporting is configured to store Bug Reports in the device via the Group Store in Device Detail, a timer will be started for the specified timeout value and when that timer expires, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will cease storing Bug Reports in the device, until the configuration is explicitly changed again.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportStorageTTL
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Never Expire | 0 |
1 Day | 1 |
1 Week | 7 |
2 Weeks | 14 |
1 Month | 30 |
3 Months | 90 |
6 Months | 180 |
1 Year | 365 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Send Via Email Detail
Use this Sub-group to configure State, SMTP Host, SMTP Port, Sender ID, Sender Password, Send To Address, and Time to Live.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportEmailDetails
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
State
Select whether Zebra Extended Bug Reporting should automatically send copies of generated Bug Reports via email.
- If the value Off is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will NOT send copies of generated Bug Reports via email.
- If the value On is selected, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting, if enabled, will send copies of generated Bug Reports via email. You should also specify additional information to provide the details of the email to be sent.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportEmailEnable
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | False |
On | True |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
SMTP Host
Enter the address or host name of the SMTP (email) Server via which emails will be sent to deliver generated Bug Reports, and should be specified when the value On is selected for State.
Note that you must have access to an email account on the selected SMTP Server and you must specify additional configuration within the Group to configure Zebra Extended Bug Reporting to send emails via that SMTP Server. In addition, you must have access to a valid email account to use as the destination of the emails, which is NOT required to be on the same SMTP Server, and must specify details of the email address within the Group, to configure Zebra Extended Bug Reporting to send the emails to that destination.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportEmailSMTPHost
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
SMTP Port
Enter the TCP port number of the SMTP (email) Server via which emails will be sent to deliver generated Bug Reports when SMTP Host is specified.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportEmailSMTPPort
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Sender ID
Enter the ID of the email account that will be used as the source (from address) of emails that will be sent to deliver generated Bug Reports, and should be specified when the value On is selected for State and when a valid SMTP (email) Server is specified via SMTP Host.
Note that you must have access to a valid email account on the configured SMTP (email) Server and must specify additional information in the Group, such as Sender Password to enable Zebra Extended Bug Reporting to successfully send the emails using that account via that server.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportEmailSendersID
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Sender Password
Enter the password of the email account that will be used as the source (from address) of emails that will be sent to deliver generated Bug Reports, and should be specified when the value On is selected for State and a valid SMTP (email) Server is specified via SMTP Host and a valid email address is specified via Sender ID.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportEmailSendersPassword
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Send To Address
Enter the email address of the email account that will be used as the destination (to address) of emails that will be sent to deliver generated Bug Reports, and should be specified when the value On is selected for State.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportEmailSendTo
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Time to Live
Select a timeout value, the expiration of which will cause the sending of Bug Reports via email to automatically cease.
- If the value Never Expire is selected, and Zebra Extended Bug Reporting is configured to send Bug Reports to the Zebra Cloud Server via the Group Send Via Email Detail, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will continue to send Bug Reports via email, until the configuration is explicitly changed again.
- If any other value is selected, at the time Zebra Extended Bug Reporting is configured to send Bug Reports via email via the Group Send Via Email Detail, Zebra Extended Bug Reporting will start a timer from the specified timeout value and will cease sending Bug Reports via email when the timer expires, until the configuration is explicitly changed again.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportEmailTTL
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Never Expire | 0 |
1 Day | 1 |
1 Week | 7 |
2 Weeks | 14 |
1 Month | 30 |
3 Months | 90 |
6 Months | 180 |
1 Year | 365 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Dialog Elements
Use this Sub-array to configure one or more Element Detail(s).
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportDialogElements
Type = bundle_array
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Element Detail
Use this Sub-group to configure Type, Error Name Text Box Text, Label Text, and Text Box Text.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportDialogElement
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Type
Select the type of a single dialog element being included in the dialog that will be presented to the device user to collect information that will be included in generated Bug Reports.
- If the value ErrorNameTextBox is selected, a text box will be added to the dialog presented to the device user in which the name to be assigned to the Bug Report being generated can be entered. You must also specify Error Name Text Box Text to provide a text to be pre-populated into the text box.
- If the value Label is selected, a text label will be added to the dialog presented to the device user. You must also specify Label Text to provide the text to be populated into the label.
- If the value TextBox is selected, a text box will be added to the dialog presented to the device user in which generic text can be entered. You must also specify Text Box Text to provide the text to be pre-populated into the text box. The specified text will to provide guidance to the device user about the expected value and will disappear when the user begins typing into the text box.
- If the value VoiceRecordButton is selected, a voice record button will be added to the dialog presented to the device user. Clicking this button will allow the device user to record a verbal explanation of the bug to be attached to the generated Bug Report.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportDialogElementType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
ErrorNameTextBox | AddErrorNameTextBox |
Label | AddLabel |
TextBox | AddTextBox |
VoiceRecordButton | AddVoiceRecordButton |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Error Name Text Box Text
Enter the text to be pre-populated into a text box that will be added to the dialog presented to the device user in which the name to be assigned to the Bug Report being generated can be entered and should be specified when the value ErrorNameTextBox is selected for Type.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportDialogElementTypeErrorNameTextBoxText
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Label Text
Enter the text of a label that will be added to the dialog presented to the device user when the value Label is selected for Type.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportDialogElementTypeLabelText
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Text Box Text
Enter the text that be pre-populated into a text box added to the dialog presented to the device user into which generic text can be entered and should be specified when the value TextBox is selected for Type. The specified text should provide guidance to the device user about the value they should enter and will be overwritted by the value entered into the text box.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportDialogElementTypeTextBoxText
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Dialog Time Out
Enter the amount of inactivity time (time in milliseconds with no device user activity), after which the dialog presented to the device user will automatically be dismissed, causing the Bug Report to be completed as if the device user had explicitly clicked the Submit Button.
Detail Information:
Key = bugreportDialogTimeout
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Camera Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Use Of Back Camera, Use Of Front Camera, and Use Of Imager.
Detail Information:
Key = cameraStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Use Of Back Camera
Select whether the Rear Facing Camera, if present on a device, can be used to take pictures.
- If the value Off is selected, no applications or services running on the device will be allowed to take pictures using the Rear Facing Camera.
- If the value On is selected, any applications or services running on the device will be allowed to take pictures using the Rear Facing Camera.
Detail Information:
Key = cameraUseOfBack
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Use Of Front Camera
Select whether the Front Facing (selfie) Camera, if present on a device, can be used to take pictures.
- If the value Off is selected, no applications or services running on the device will be allowed to take pictures using the Front Facing (selfie) Camera.
- If the value On is selected, any applications or services running on the device will be allowed to take pictures using the Front Facing (selfie) Camera.
Detail Information:
Key = cameraUseOfFront
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Use Of Imager
Select whether the Imager (special-purpose image capture device), if present on a device, can be used to take pictures.
- If the value Off is selected, no applications or services running on the device will be allowed to take pictures using the Imager (special-purpose image capture device) Camera.
- If the value On is selected, any applications or services running on the device will be allowed to take pictures using the Imager (special-purpose image capture device) Camera.
Detail Information:
Key = cameraUseOfImager
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.1.
Clock Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Time Mode, Manual Date, Manual Time, Manual UTC Date, Manual UTC Time, Auto NTP Server Address, Auto NTP Sync Interval, Time Zone Mode, Zone, and Time Format.
Detail Information:
Key = clockStep
Type = bundle
Time Mode
Select whether time and date configuration will be performed explicitly, through configuration, or automatically, by connecting to a Network Time Protocol (NTP) Server.
If the value Manual is selected, you should also specify one or more of the following: Manual UTC Date, Manual UTC Time, Manual Date, or Manual Time.
If the value Auto is selected, you must also specify Auto NTP Server Address and Auto NTP Sync Interval.
Detail Information:
Key = clockTimeMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Manual | false |
Auto | true |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Manual Date
Enter the date to be set on a device when the value Manual is selected for Time Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = clockManualDate
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.1.
Manual Time
Enter the time to be set on a device when the value Manual is selected for Time Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = clockManualTime
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.1.
Manual UTC Date
Enter the date to be set on a device normalized to universal time (UTC) when the value Manual is selected for Time Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = clockManualDateUTC
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.2.
Manual UTC Time
Enter the time to be set on a device normalized to universal time (UTC) when the value Manual is selected for Time Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = clockManualTimeUTC
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.2.
Auto NTP Server Address
Enter the address of the Network Time Protocol (NTP) Server to be used to perform automatic date and time configuration on a device when the value Auto is selected for Time Mode. You must also specify Auto NTP Sync Interval to provide the interval at which the time should be acquired from the specified server.
Detail Information:
Key = clockAutoNtpServer
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Auto NTP Sync Interval
Enter the interval at which automatic date and time configuration will be performed on a device when the value Auto is selected for Time Mode and when Auto NTP Server Address is specified.
Detail Information:
Key = clockAutoNtpSyncInterval
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
30 minutes | 00:30:00 |
60 minutes | 00:60:00 |
6 hours | 06:00:00 |
24 hours | 24:00:00 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Time Zone Mode
Select whether time zone configuration will be performed explicitly, using other configurations in the Group, or automatically, by connecting to a Network Identity and Time Zone (NITZ) source.
Detail Information:
Key = clockTimeZoneMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Manual | false |
Auto | true |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.0.
Zone
Enter the time zone to be set on a device when the value Manual is selected for Time Zone Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = clockManualTimeZone
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.1.
Time Format
Select whether the format in which time will be displayed on the device will be in 12 hour (AM/PM) or 24 hour (military) format.
Detail Information:
Key = clockTimeFormat
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
12 | 2 |
24 | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.0.
DataWedge Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Database File, NG Simulscan Template File, Manual, and Programmatic Import.
Detail Information:
Key = dataWedgeStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Database File
Enter the device path and file name of a DataWedge Database file (full or partial) to replace or be merged to modify the current configuration of DataWedge.
Detail Information:
Key = dataWedgeDatabaseFile
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
NG Simulscan Template File
Enter the device path and file name of a valid Simulscan template file to be imported to replace or add to DataWedge.
Detail Information:
Key = dataWedgeSimulscanTemplateFile
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.0.
Manual Configuration
Select whether device users will be allowed to manually alter the configuration of DataWedge from the DataWedge configuration UI.API.
Detail Information:
Key = dataWedgeManualConfiguration
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Programmatic Import
Select whether whether applications will be allowed to programmatically import DataWedge Configuration Files using the DataWedge Intent API.
Detail Information:
Key = dataWedgeApiImport
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Device Administration Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Action, Allow Submit XML Package Name, Disallow Submit XML Package Name, Submit XML, Allow Package Update Package Name, Disallow Package Update Package Name, Reserve User ID Package Name, Unreserve User ID Package Name, Lock Screen Wallpaper, Custom Lock Screen Wallpaper, App Management Notifications, Notifications on Lock Screen, and Secure Start-up Selection by device user.
Detail Information:
Key = devadminStep
Type = bundle
Action
Select an Action to control access to or utilize the Zebra MX Management System on a device.
- If the value Allow App To Submit Xml is selected, a single application or service is allowed to submit XML for processing by the Zebra MX Management System. You must also specify Allow Submit XML Package Name to provide the Android Package Name that identifies the application or service is to be allowed.
- If the value Disallow App From Submitting Xml is selected, a single application service is disallowed from submitting XML for processing by the Zebra MX Management System. You must also specify Disallow Submit XML Package Name to provide the Android Package Name that identifies the application or service is to be disallowed.
- If the value Submit Xml is selected, you must also specify Submit XML to provide the XML string that will be submitted for processing by the .Zebra MX Management System.
- If the value Reserve UID for App is selected, you must also specify Reserve User ID Package Name to identify the particular package to which the User ID is reserved.
- You must also specify Reserve User ID Package Signature to assure that the package to which the User ID is reserved is the right one.
- If the value Unreserve UID for App is selected, you must also specify Unreserve User ID Package Name to identify the particular package to which the User ID is reserved.
- If the value Allow App To Update is selected, you must also specify Allow Package Update Package Name to identify the particular package allowed to be updated. This is only necessary for applications that were previously disallowed using Disallow App From Update
- If the value Disallow App From Update is selected, you must also specify Disallow Package Update Package Name to identify the particular package to be prevented from being updated.
Detail Information:
Key = devadminAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Allow App To Submit Xml | AllowSubmitXml |
Disallow App From Submitting Xml | DisallowSubmitXml |
Submit Xml | SubmitXml |
Reserve UID for App | ReserveUID |
Unreserve UID for App | UnreserveUID |
Allow App To Update | AllowApplicationUpgrade |
Disallow App From Update | DisallowApplicationUpgrade |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Allow Submit XML Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name that identifies the application or service is to be allowed when the value Allow App To Submit Xml is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = devadminActionAllowSubmitXmlPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Disallow Submit XML Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name that identifies the application or service is to be disallowed when the value Disallow App From Submitting Xml is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = devadminActionDisallowSubmitXmlPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Submit XML
Enter an XML string to be submitted for processing by the .Zebra MX Management System, when the value Submit Xml is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = devadminActionSubmitXml
Type = string
Allow Package Update Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name of the application allowed to be updated, when the value Allow App To Update is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = devadminActionAllowUpdatePackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.3.
Disallow Package Update Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name of the application not allowed to be updated, when the value Disallow App From Update is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = devadminActionDisallowUpdatePackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.3.
Reserve User ID Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name of the application needing a reserved UID, when the value Reserve UID for App is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = devadminActionReserveUIDPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Unreserve User ID Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name of the application whose user ID can be released (unreserved), when the value Unreserve UID for App is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = devadminActionUnreserveUIDPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock Screen Wallpaper
Select the wallpaper to use on the lock screen of the device.
- If the value Restore to default is selected, the default lock screen wallpaper will be used.
- If the value Custom is selected, the custom wallpaper specified in Custom Lock Screen Wallpaper will be used on the lock screen.
Detail Information:
Key = daLockScreenWallpaper
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Restore to default | 1 |
Custom | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Support discontinued from: MX 11.0.
Custom Lock Screen Wallpaper
Enter the path and file name of an image file on the device (.jpg or .png)
Detail Information:
Key = daCustomLockWallpaper
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Support discontinued from: MX 11.0.
App Management Notifications
Select whether the device user receives notifications when the Device Owner installs, uninstalls or upgrades applications. Applies to Android 11 and later.
- If the value Show is selected, notifications will be shown to the user when the Device Owner installs, uninstalls, or upgrades applications.
- If the value Hide is selected, no notifications will be shown to the user when the Device Owner installs, uninstalls, or upgrades applications. s
Detail Information:
Key = daSilentAppInstall
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Show | 1 |
Hide | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Notifications on Lock Screen
Select the types of notifications to show on the lock screen
- If the value Show all content is selected, all notifications will be shown.
- If the value Show only non-sensitive content is selected, only non-sensitive content will be shown.
- If the value Hide notifications is selected, all notifications will be hidden.
Detail Information:
Key = daNotificationsOnLockScreen
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Show all content | 1 |
Show only non-sensitive content | 2 |
Hide notifications | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Support discontinued from: MX 11.0.
Secure Start-up Selection by device user
Select whether device user will be allowed to Select Secure Start-up when changing pin/password/pattern.
Detail Information:
Key = secureStartupDialog
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Enable the YES button | 1 |
Disable the YES button | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.0.
Device Central Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Bluetooth On/Off Control, Bluetooth Pairing Control, and Firmware Update Button.
Detail Information:
Key = deviceCentralStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Bluetooth On/Off Control
Select whether the device user should be allowed to use the Device Central UI to control Bluetooth Power.
If the value Disallow is selected, Device Central will NOT provide UI that allows the device user to control the Bluetooth power state.
If the value Allow is selected, Device Central will provide UI that allows the device user to control the Bluetooth power state.
Detail Information:
Key = deviceCentralBluetoothOnOffControl
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Bluetooth Pairing Control
Select whether Device Central system should allow multiple pairings to the same Device Class. This feature has been deprecated in Device Central. Look in the Bluetooth Configuration
- If the value Single Pairing Per Device Class is selected, Device Central system will only allow one pairing at a time for each Bluetooth Device Class (e.g. one headset and one printer).
- If the value Multiple Pairings Per Device Class is selected, Device Central system will allow multiple pairings at a time for each Bluetooth Device Class (e.g. multiple headsets and/or multiple printers).
Detail Information:
Key = deviceCentralBluetoothPairingControl
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Single Pairing Per Device Class | 1 |
Multiple Pairings Per Device Class | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Firmware Update Button
Select whether the device user should be allowed to use the Device Central UI to initiate a Firmware Update.
- If the value Disallow is selected, Device Central will NOT provide UI that allows the device user to initiate a Firmware Update.
- If the value Allow is selected, Device Central will provide UI that allows the device user to initiate a Firmware Update.
Detail Information:
Key = deviceCentralFirmwareUpdateButton
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
DHCP Option Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Request Boot File Name (Option 67), Request NTP Server (Option 42), Request TFTP Server Address (Option 66), Request Domain Search List (Option 119), Request TFTP Server Names (Option 150), Request Vendor Specific Option#1 (Option 186), Request Vendor Specific Option#2 (Option 188), Request Vendor Specific Option#3 (Option 230), Send Client Identifier State (Option 61), Send Client Identifier Value (Option 61), Send Host Name State (Option 12), Send Host Name Value (Option 12), Send User Class State (Option 77), Send User Class Value (Option 77), Send Vendor Class State (Option 60), Send Vendor Class Value (Option 60), Send FQDN State (Option 81), Send FQDN Value (Option 81), Send FQDN Flag (Option 81), Request Custom Option Number, Request Custom Option State, Send Custom Option Number, Send Custom Option State, and Send Custom Option Value
The DHCP Client on the device sends a DHCP Request to a DHCP Server and receives back a DHCP Acknowledgment. A DHCP Request sent by a device can contain information about the device or the DHCP Client, and can contain requests for additional information from the DHCP Server. A DHCP Acknowledgment sent by the DHCP Server contains the IP Address assigned to the device by the DHCP Server along with other related information and any additional information requested by the device in the DHCP Request.
DHCP Options are variable-length strings that are identified by DHCP Options Numbers that can be included in a DHCP Request or a DHCP Acknowledgment to convey information between a DHCP Client and a DHCP Server. From the point of view of the device where the DHCP Client is running, a DHCP Option can allow the DHCP Client to Send information to the DHCP Server or can allow the DHCP Client to Request the DHCP Server to return information to the DHCP Client.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpStep
Type = bundle
Request Boot File Name (Option 67)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will request that the DHCP Server acquire the Boot File Name and return it using DHCP Option 67 along with the IP Address.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpRequestBootFileName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.4.
Request NTP Server (Option 42)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will request that the DHCP Server acquire the NTP Server and return it using DHCP Option 42 along with the IP Address.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpRequestNtpServer
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.4.
Request TFTP Server Address (Option 66)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will request that the DHCP Server acquire the TFTP Server Address and return it using DHCP Option 66 along with the IP Address.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpRequestTftpServerAddress
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.4.
Request Domain Search List (Option 119)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will request that the DHCP Server acquire the Domain Search List and return it using DHCP Option 119 along with the IP Address.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpRequestDomainSearchList
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.4.
Request TFTP Server Names (Option 150)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will request that the DHCP Server acquire the TFTP Server Name(s) and return it using DHCP Option 150 along with the IP Address.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpRequestTftpServerNames
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.4.
Request Vendor Specific Option#1 (Option 186)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will request that the DHCP Server acquire the First Vendor Specific Option and return it using DHCP Option 186 along with the IP Address.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpRequestVendorSpecific1
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.5.
Request Vendor Specific Option#2 (Option 188)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will request that the DHCP Server acquire the Second Vendor Specific Option and return it using DHCP Option 188 along with the IP Address.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpRequestVendorSpecific2
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.5.
Request Vendor Specific Option#3 (Option 230)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will request that the DHCP Server acquire the Third Vendor Specific Option and return it using DHCP Option 230 along with the IP Address.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpRequestVendorSpecific3
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Send Client Identifier State (Option 61)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will send a Client Identifier to the DHCP Server using DHCP Option 61 when requesting an IP Address.
- If the value Off is selected, you do not need to specify any additional information.
- If the value On is selected, you must also specify Send Client Identifier State (Option 61) to provide the value of the Client Identifier to be sent.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendClientIdentifierState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Send Client Identifier Value (Option 61)
Enter the Client Identifier that the DHCP Client on a device will send to the DHCP Server using DHCP Option 12 when requesting an IP Address when the value On is selected for Send Client Identifier State (Option 61).
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendClientIdentifierValue
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Send Host Name State (Option 12)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will send a Host Name to the DHCP Server using DHCP Option 12 when requesting an IP Address.
- If the value Off is selected, you do not need to specify any additional information.
- If the value On is selected, you must also specify Send Host Name Value (Option 12) to provide the value of the Host Name to be sent.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendHostNameState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.4.
Send Host Name Value (Option 12)
Enter the Host Name that the DHCP Client on a device will send to the DHCP Server using DHCP Option 12 when requesting an IP Address when the value On is selected for Send Host Name State (Option 12).
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendHostNameValue
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.4.
Send User Class State (Option 77)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will send a User Class to the DHCP Server using DHCP Option 77 when requesting an IP Address.
- If the value Off is selected, you do not need to specify any additional information.
- If the value On is selected, you must also specify Send User Class Value (Option 77) to provide the value of the User Class to be sent.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendUserClassState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.4.
Send User Class Value (Option 77)
Enter the User Class that the DHCP Client on a device will send to the DHCP Server using DHCP Option 77 when requesting an IP Address when the value On is selected for Send User Class State (Option 77).
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendUserClassValue
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.4.
Send Vendor Class State (Option 60)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will send a Vendor Class to the DHCP Server using DHCP Option 60 when requesting an IP Address.
- If the value Off is selected, you do not need to specify any additional information.
- If the value On is selected, you must also specify Send Vendor Class Value (Option 60) to provide the value of the Vendor Class to be sent.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendVendorClassState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.5.
Send Vendor Class Value (Option 60)
Enter the Vendor Class that the DHCP Client on a device will send to the DHCP Server using DHCP Option 60 when requesting an IP Address when the value On is selected for Send Vendor Class State (Option 60).
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendVendorClassValue
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.5.
Send FQDN State (Option 81)
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will send a Fully Qualified Domain Name (FQDN) to the DHCP Server using DHCP Option 81 when requesting an IP Address.
- If the value Off is selected, you do not need to specify any additional information.
- If the value On is selected, you must also specify Send FQDN Value (Option 81) and Send FQDN Flag (Option 81) to provide the value of the FQDN value and the associated flags to be sent.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendFqdnState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Send FQDN Value (Option 81)
Enter the Fully Qualified Domain Name (FQDN) that will be sent to the DHCP Server using DHCP Option 81 when requesting an IP Address when the value On is selected for Send FQDN State (Option 81). You must also specify Send FQDN Flag (Option 81) to provide the flags to be sent along with the FQDN value.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendFqdnValue
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Send FQDN Flag (Option 81)
Enter the flags to be sent along with the Fully Qualified Domain Name (FQDN) that will be sent to the DHCP Server using DHCP Option 81 when requesting an IP Address when the value On is selected for Send FQDN State (Option 81) and when Send FQDN Value (Option 81) is specified.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendFqdnFlag
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Request Custom Option Number
Enter the option number of a custom DHCP Option that the DHCP Client on a device should request from DHCP Server and return along with the IP Address when the value On is selected for Request Custom Option State.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpRequestCustomOptionNumber
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Request Custom Option State
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will request that the DHCP Server acquire a custom DHCP option and return it along with the IP Address.
- If the value Off is selected, no custom DHCP Option will be requested and you do not need to specify any additional information.
- If the value On is selected, a custom DHCP Option will be requested and you must also specify Request Custom Option Number to provide the custom option number to be requested.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpRequestCustomOptionState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Send Custom Option Number
Enter the option number of a custom DHCP Option that the DHCP Client on a device should send when requesting an IP Address when the value On is selected for Send Custom Option State.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendCustomOptionNumber
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Send Custom Option State
Select whether the DHCP Client on a device will request that the DHCP Server send a custom DHCP option when requesting an IP Address.
- If the value Off is selected, no custom DHCP Option will be sent you do not need to specify any additional information.
- If the value On is selected, a custom DHCP Option will be sent and you must also specify Send Custom Option Number to provide the custom option number to be sent and Send Custom Option Value to provide the custom option value to be sent.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendCustomOptionState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
On | 1 |
Off | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Send Custom Option Value
Enter the option value for a custom DHCP Option that the DHCP Client on a device should send when requesting an IP Address when the value On is selected for Send Custom Option State and when Send Custom Option Number is specified.
Detail Information:
Key = dhcpSendCustomOptionValue
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Display Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Force Activities Resizable, Resizable Windows, Secondary Display Mode, Secondary Display Remote Control, Timeout, Blanking Mode, Stay Awake, Signal, Polarity, Debounce Delay, Allowed Orientations, Deprecated Rotation Mode, Lock Override Button, Locked Orientation Positions, Rotation Mode, Set Display Size, Set Font Size, Backlight Adaptive Brightness, and Brightness.
Detail Information:
Key = displayStep
Type = bundle
Force Activities Resizable
Select whether the device display and secondary display will force activities to be treated as resizable even if not declared in the application manifest.
If All Activities Resizable is selected, all activities running on the device display and secondary display will be forced to be treated as resizable even if not declared in the application manifest.
If Follow Application Manifest is selected, activities will be treated as resizable only if declared to be resizable in the application manifest.
Detail Information:
Key = displayForceActivitiesResizable
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
All Activities Resizable | 1 |
Follow Application Manifest | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.5.
Resizable Windows
Select whether the device display and secondary display will support resizable windows.
If Turn On is selected, the device display and secondary display will allow resizing of windows.
If Turn Off is selected, the device display and secondary display will NOT allow resizing of windows.
Detail Information:
Key = displayResizableWindows
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Turn On | 1 |
Turn Off | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.5.
Secondary Display Mode
Select the mode to use for the secondary display.
If Present Independent Desktop is selected, the secondary display will present a desktop that is independent from the device screen.
If Mirror Device Screen is selected, the secondary display will present a duplicate (mirror) of the device screen.
Detail Information:
Key = secondaryDisplayMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Present Independent Desktop | 1 |
Mirror Device Screen | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.5.
Secondary Display Remote Control
Select the display on which remote operations will be performed.
If Primary (Mobile) is selected, remote control operations will be performed on the primary (mobile) display
If Secondary (Desktop) is selected, remote control operations will be performed on the secondary (desktop) display
Detail Information:
Key = secondaryDisplayRemoteControl
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Primary (Mobile) | 0 |
Secondary (Desktop) | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 11.1.
Timeout
Select the amount of inactivity, in seconds, after which the device will timeout and automatically turn the Display Screen off.
A given device may not support all available values. In the event that a selected value is not supported on a given device, the smallest larger value that is supported will be used or, if no larger value is supported, the largest smaller value that is supported will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = displayTimeout
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
15 seconds | 15 |
30 seconds | 30 |
1 minute | 60 |
2 minutes | 120 |
5 minutes | 300 |
10 minutes | 600 |
30 minutes | 1800 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.3.
Blanking Mode
Select whether the Display will automatically Blank (display nothing) on a device.
When a device user is operating a vehicle with a vehicle-mounted device, it is often advisable, for safety or regulatory reasons, to prevent the device user from interacting with the device or being distracted by the Display of the device, while the vehicle is in motion. Display Blanking Mode provides the ability to configure the device such that the Display Screen will automatically be Blanked (display nothing) when an electrical signal (such as one attached to the accelerator) is detected that indicates that the vehicle is in motion.
At present, Display Blanking Mode is supported only on VC8x and similarly equipped vehicle-mounted Zebra mobile computers running Android.
If the value Never Blank is selected, Display Blanking Mode will be turned off and hence automatic Display Blanking will never occur.
If the value Blank When Triggered by Signal is selected, Display Blanking Mode will be turned on and hence the Display will be automatically Blanked and you must also specify all of the following:
Signal - to specify the signal that will be used to activate automatic Display Blanking.
Polarity - to specify the polarity of the signal specified via Signal that will be used to activate automatic Blanking.
Debounce Delay - to specify the time that will be used to debounce the signal specified via Signal.
Detail Information:
Key = displayBlankingMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Never Blank | 1 |
Blank When Triggered by Signal | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Stay Awake
Select whether the Display will Stay Awake (prevent automatic time out that turns the Display Screen off) when the device is connected to external power.
When a device user is operating a vehicle with a vehicle-mounted device, the device may be continuously receiving power from the vehicle power supply, rather than running off its own internal battery. The Display Screen timeout, configured via Timeout, which is generally used to increase battery life, may add little value in such situations. It may therefore be desirable to configure the device to Stay Awake and thus prevent it from timing out and turning the Display Screen off, so long as the device is connected to external power.
- If the value Off is selected, the Display will NOT Stay Awake and hence the device will time out and automatically turn the Display Screen off, when the Display Screen timeout, configured via Timeout expires, even if the device is connected to external power.
- If the value On is selected, the Display will Stay Awake and hence the device will not time out and will not automatically turn the Display Screen off, so long as the device is connected to external power, even if the Display Screen timeout, configured via Timeout expires.
Detail Information:
Key = displayStayAwake
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.2.
Signal
Select the Signal that will be used to trigger automatic Display Blanking when the value Blank When Triggered by Signal is selected for Blanking Mode to turn on Display Blanking Mode.
- If the value Input 1 is selected, on the Zebra VC80x vehicle-mounted Android device the Clear To Send (CTS) input signal on Serial Port 1 will be used to trigger automatic Display Blanking.
- If the value Input 2 is selected, on the Zebra VC80x vehicle-mounted Android device the Clear To Send (CTS) input signal on Serial Port 2 will be used to trigger automatic Display Blanking.
A common configuration to support Display Blanking Mode would be to connect the Request to Send (RTS) output signal of the selected Serial Port to the Clear To Send (CTS) input signal on the same serial port, via a switch, such as one activated by the vehicle accelerator. When the switch is activated, the output RTS output signal would be fed back into the CTS input signal and detected to trigger automatic Display Blanking.
Detail Information:
Key = displayBlankingModeSignal
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Input 1 | 1 |
Input 2 | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Polarity
Select the Polarity of the Signal that will be used to trigger automatic Display Blanking when the value Blank When Triggered by Signal is selected for Blanking Mode to turn on Display Blanking Mode.
- If the value Blank screen when signal goes inactive (OFF) is selected, the automatic Display Blanking will occur when the specified signal is detected as going inactive (OFF). This choice would be used in specialized configurations where the signal to be used to trigger automatic Display Blanking has reverse polarity.
- If the value Blank screen when signal goes active (ON) is selected, the automatic Display Blanking will occur when the specified signal is detected as going active (ON). This is the most common choice for the common configuration of connecting RTS and CTS via a switch.
Detail Information:
Key = displayBlankingModeSignalPolarity
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Blank screen when signal goes inactive (OFF) | 2 |
Blank screen when signal goes active (ON) | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Debounce Delay
Enter the Debounce Delay that will be used for the Signal that will be used to trigger automatic Display Blanking when the value Blank When Triggered by Signal is selected for Blanking Mode to turn on Display Blanking Mode.
The value specified should be in milliseconds and will be used as a delay following a change in signal state for changing the state of Display Blanking. This is useful to avoid spurious or repetitive changes in Display Blanking state as a result of bounce or chatter on the signal used to trigger automatic Display Blanking. The value specified should be in the range of 250 milliseconds (one quarter of a second) to 32767 milliseconds (more than 32 seconds), which should be adequate to handle most situations.
Detail Information:
Key = displayBlankingModeSignalDebounceDelay
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Allowed Orientations
Select which orientations are permitted when auto rotation is active.
If All (0 90 180 270 degrees) is selected, all orientations are allowed.
If All except portrait inverted (180 degrees) is selected, all orientations except inverted portrait are allowed.
Detail Information:
Key = displayAllowedOrientations
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
All (0 90 180 270 degrees) | 1 |
All except portrait inverted (180 degrees) | 2 |
Support Information:
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Support discontinued from: MX 11.0.
Deprecated Rotation Mode
Select whether the content presented on the device display will be automatically rotated, based on the accelerometer, to match the physical orientation of the device.
This managed configuration is deprecated.
It is recommended to use Rotation Mode instead to control device display rotation.
Detail Information:
Key = setMirrorAutorotate
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Lock to Current | 0 |
Automatic | 1 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Pie.
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.1.
Lock Override Button
Select whether the device user is allowed to override the locked screen orientation.
If Enable is selected, the device user is allowed to override the locked screen orientation.
if Disable is selected, the device user is not allowed to override the locked screen orientation.
Detail Information:
Key = displayLockOverrideButton
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Enable | 1 |
Disable | 2 |
Support Information:
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Support discontinued from: MX 11.0.
Locked Orientation Positions
Select an orientation in which to lock the display when autorotation is turned off.
If Portrait (No rotation) is selected, portrait (no rotation) is locked.
If Landscape left (90 degrees) is selected, landscape left (90 degrees) is locked.
if Portrait inverted (180 degrees) is selected, portrait inverted (180 degrees) is locked.
if Landscape right (270 degrees) is selected, landscape right (270 degrees) is locked.
Detail Information:
Key = displayLockedOrientation
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Portrait (No rotation) | 0 |
Landscape left (90 degrees) | 1 |
Portrait inverted (180 degrees) | 2 |
Landscape right (270 degrees) | 3 |
Support Information:
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Support discontinued from: MX 11.0.
Rotation Mode
Select whether the content presented on the device display will be automatically rotated, based on the accelerometer, to match the physical orientation of the device.
If Lock to Current is selected, the content presented on the device display will remain locked in whatever orientation it was in at the time this setting was changed from Automatic to Lock to Current.
If Automatic is selected, the content presented on the device display will be automatically rotated, based on the accelerometer, to match the physical orientation of the device.
Notes:
No method is currently provided to set the orientation when a device is locked or being locked. Locking results are unpredictable if performed in conditions under which the physical orientation of the device is not known (e.g. while the device is in use). For best results, locking should be performed when the device is in a known orientation (such as when docked or in a charging cradle).
The Lock to Current setting can be overridden by an application that's coded to do so. This can be useful if the app functions only in a particular orientation or if that orientation provides a better user experience.
Detail Information:
Key = displayRotationMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Lock to Current | Turn Off |
Automatic | Turn On |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.1.
Set Display Size
Select the system display size to one of several pre-defined sizes.
Detail Information:
Key = setDisplaySize
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Small | SMALL |
Default | DEFAULT |
Large | LARGE |
Larger | LARGER |
Largest | LARGEST |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Set Font Size
Select the system font size
Detail Information:
Key = setFontSize
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Small | 0.85 |
Default | 1.0 |
Large | 1.15 |
Largest | 1.3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Backlight Adaptive Brightness
Select whether the screen brightness will be set automatically based on the environment. This setting is equivalent to the adaptive brightness check box found in the settings app.
Detail Information:
Key = displayBacklightAdaptiveBrightness
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.2.
Brightness
Enter the Backlight Brightness when the value Off is selected for Backlight Adaptive Brightness.
Detail Information:
Key = displayBacklightBrightness
Type = integer
Enterprise Keyboard Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Auto Capitalization, Auto Correction, Block Offensive Words, Double Space Period, Flick for Alternate Chars, Key Long Press Delay, Language Action, Language, Custom, Navigation Mode, Numeric Layout Mode, Show Alphanumeric Tab, Show Numeric Tab, Show Scan Tab, Show Symbol Tab, Show Voice Input Key, System Language Support, Preferred Tab, Suggest Contact Names, Suggest Misspelling Corrections, Popup on Keypress, Sound on Keypress, Mode, Volume, Vibrate on Keypress, Mode, Duration, Remap Alpha P1, Remap Numeric P1, Remap Numeric P2, Remap Numeric P3, Remap Numeric P4, and Remap Symbol P1.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Auto Capitalization
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will have automatic capitalization turned on (enabled) or turned off (disabled) for the first letter of each sentence.
- If the value Off is selected, automatic capitalization will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, automatic capitalization will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbAutoCaps
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Auto Correction
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will have automatic correction of misspelled words turned on (enabled) or turned off (disabled), wherein the space and punctuation keys initiate automatic correction of misspelled words.
- If the value Off is selected, automatic correction of misspelled words will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, automatic correction of misspelled words will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbAutoCorrection
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Block Offensive Words
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will have automatic blocking of offensive words turned on (enabled) or turned off (disabled).
- If the value Off is selected, automatic offensive word blocking will be turned off (disabled).
- If the value On is selected, automatic offensive word blocking will be turned on (enabled).
Detail Information:
Key = ekbBlockOffensiveWords
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Double Space Period
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will have automatic sentence ending turned on (enabled) or turned off (disabled) wherein a double tap on the space key causes the entry of a period followed by two spaces.
- If the value Off is selected, this feature will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, this feature will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbDoubleSpacePeriod
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Flick for Alternate Chars
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will show alternate characters when a flick gesture is performed.
- If the value Off is selected, this feature will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, this feature will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbFlickForAlternateChars
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.1.
Key Long Press Delay
Enter the length of time (in milliseconds) that a key within the Enterprise Keyboard on a device need to be held pressed to be detected as a long press.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbKeyLongPressDelay
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Language Action
Select the action to take for the selected language
Detail Information:
Key = ekbLanguageAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Enable | 1 |
Disable | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.1.
Language
Select the language acted upon
Detail Information:
Key = ekbLanguageActionLanguage
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
English_US | English_US |
English_UK | English_UK |
Polish | Polish |
Slovak | Slovak |
Romanian | Romanian |
Czech | Czech |
Russian | Russian |
ALL | ALL |
CUSTOM | CUSTOM |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.1.
Custom
Enter the custom language
Detail Information:
Key = ekbLanguageActionLanguageCustom
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.1.
Navigation Mode
Select the navigation mode the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will use to provide its user experience.
- If the value Tab-based (new) is selected, the Enterprise Keyboard will use the new user experience wherein different tabs can be used to select the desired keyboard.
- If the value Key-based (legacy) is selected, the Enterprise Keyboard will use the legacy user experience wherein keys can be used to select the desired keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbNavigationMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Tab-based (new) | 1 |
Key-based (legacy) | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Numeric Layout Mode
Select the numeric layout mode the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will use when it determines that a numeric keyboard should be displayed.
- If the value Telephone Mode is selected, the Enterprise Keyboard will display a numeric keyboard in telephone mode (e.g. 123, 456, 789).
- If the value Calculator Mode is selected, the Enterprise Keyboard will display a numeric keyboard in calculator mode (e.g. 789, 456, 123).
Detail Information:
Key = ekbNumericLayoutMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Telephone Mode | 1 |
Calculator Mode | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.1.
Show Alphanumeric Tab
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will show the alphanumeric tab to allow selection of the alphanumeric keyboard.
- If the value Off is selected, this feature will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, this feature will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbShowAlphaNumericTab
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Show Numeric Tab
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will show the numeric tab to allow selection of the numeric keyboard.
- If the value Off is selected, this feature will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, this feature will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbShowNumericTab
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Show Scan Tab
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will show the scan tab to allow control of barcode scanning.
- If the value Off is selected, this feature will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, this feature will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbShowScanTab
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Show Symbol Tab
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will show the symbol tab to allow selection of the special symbols keyboard.
- If the value Off is selected, this feature will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, this feature will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbShowSymbolTab
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Show Voice Input Key
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will show a key to invoke voice input (if supported).
- If the value Off is selected, this feature will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, this feature will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbShowVoiceInputKey
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
System Language Support
Select whether to use the standard Android Languages or the built-in Enterprise Keyboard languages.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbUseSystemLanguages
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Android System | 1 |
Enterprise Keyboard | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.1.
Preferred Tab
Select the preferred tab the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will select by default when textual data is being entered.
- If the value Numeric is selected, the Enterprise Keyboard will select the Numeric tab by default when textual data is being entered.
- If the value Alphanumeric is selected, the Enterprise Keyboard will show the Alphanumeric tab by default when textual data is being entered.
- If the value Symbol is selected, the Enterprise Keyboard will show the Symbol tab by default when textual data is being entered.
- If the value Scan is selected, the Enterprise Keyboard will show the Scan tab by default when textual data is being entered.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbSelectPreferredTab
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Numeric | 1 |
Alphanumeric | 2 |
Symbol | 3 |
Scan | 4 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Suggest Contact Names
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device showing contact name suggestions while typing based on past actions will be turned on (enabled) or turned off (disabled).
- If the value Off is selected, contact name suggestions will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, contact name suggestions will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbShowContactNamesSuggestions
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Suggest Misspelling Corrections
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device showing suggestions for corrections of misspelled words while typing will be turned on (enabled) or turned off (disabled).
- If the value Off is selected, correction suggestions will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, correction suggestions will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbShowCorrectionSuggestions
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Popup on Keypress
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will have key popup on each keypress turned on (enabled) or turned off (disabled) wherein a visible indication that thekey was pressed occurs.
- If the value Off is selected, this feature will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, this feature will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbPopupOnKeypress
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Sound on Keypress
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will have sound on each keypress turned on (enabled) or turned off (disabled) wherein an audible indication that the key was pressed occurs.
- If the value Off is selected, this feature will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, this feature will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbSoundOnKeypress
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Mode
Select the volume mode that will be used by the Enterprise Keyboard on a device when sound occurs on each keypress.
- If the value System Default Volume is selected, the System Default Volume for keypress sounds will be used.
- If the value Specified Volume is selected, a specified volume will be used and you must also specify Volume to provide that volume.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbSoundOnKeypressVolumeMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
System Default Volume | 2 |
Specified Volume | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Volume
Enter the volume (from 0 to 100) that will be used by the Enterprise Keyboard on a device when sound occurs on each keypress, when the value On is selected for Sound on Keypress and the value System Default Volume is selected for Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbSoundOnKeypressVolume
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Vibrate on Keypress
Select whether the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will have vibration on each keypress turned on (enabled) or turned off (disabled) wherein a tactile indication that the key was pressed occurs.
- If the value Off is selected, this feature will be turned off (disabled), and hence it will not be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
- If the value On is selected, this feature will be turned on (enabled), and hence it will be available for use in entering data using the Enterprise Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbVibrateOnKeypress
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Mode
Select the duration mode that will be used by the Enterprise Keyboard on a device when vibrate occurs on each keypress.
- If the value System Default Duration is selected, the System Default Duration for keypress vibrate will be used.
- If the value Specified Duration is selected, a specified duration will be used and you must also specify Duration to provide that duration.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbVibrateOnKeypressDurationMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
System Default Duration | 2 |
Specified Duration | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Duration
Enter the duration (from 0 to 100 milliseconds) that will be used by the Enterprise Keyboard on a device when a vibrate occurs on each keypress, when the value On is selected for Vibrate on Keypress and the value System Default Duration is selected for Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbVibrateOnKeypressDuration
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Remap Alpha P1
Enter a value that defines the behavior the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will perform when the Alpha P1 Key (located on the Alpha keyboard at Row 1, Column 1) is pressed.
Possible values can be:
- A single character value (e.g. the letter "A" or the symbol "@") causes that character value to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key.
- A hexadecimal value in the format \uXXXXXX (e.g. \u000001) causes the specified key code to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key. Allowable values can be determined from the Android documentation: https://developer.android.com/reference/android/view/KeyEvent.
- The value \EMOJI causes the remapped key to switch to the EMOJI keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbRemapAlphaP1
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Remap Numeric P1
Enter a value that defines the behavior the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will perform when the Numeric P1 Key (located on the Numeric keyboard at Row 1, Column 1) is pressed.
Possible values can be: - A single character value (e.g. the letter "A" or the symbol "@") causes that character value to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key.
- A hexadecimal value in the format \uXXXXXX (e.g. \u000001) causes the specified key code to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key. Allowable values can be determined from the Android documentation: https://developer.android.com/reference/android/view/KeyEvent.
- The value \EMOJI causes the remapped key to switch to the EMOJI keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbRemapNumericP1
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Remap Numeric P2
Enter a value that defines the behavior the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will perform when the Numeric P2 Key (located on the Numeric keyboard at Row 2, Column 1) is pressed.
Possible values can be: - A single character value (e.g. the letter "A" or the symbol "@") causes that character value to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key.
- A hexadecimal value in the format \uXXXXXX (e.g. \u000001) causes the specified key code to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key. Allowable values can be determined from the Android documentation: https://developer.android.com/reference/android/view/KeyEvent.
- The value \EMOJI causes the remapped key to switch to the EMOJI keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbRemapNumericP2
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Remap Numeric P3
Enter a value that defines the behavior the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will perform when the Numeric P3 Key (located on the Numeric keyboard at Row 3, Column 1) is pressed.
Possible values can be: - A single character value (e.g. the letter "A" or the symbol "@") causes that character value to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key.
- A hexadecimal value in the format \uXXXXXX (e.g. \u000001) causes the specified key code to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key. Allowable values can be determined from the Android documentation: https://developer.android.com/reference/android/view/KeyEvent.
- The value \EMOJI causes the remapped key to switch to the EMOJI keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbRemapNumericP3
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Remap Numeric P4
Enter a value that defines the behavior the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will perform when the Numeric P4 Key (located on the Numeric keyboard at Row 4, Column 1) is pressed.
Possible values can be: - A single character value (e.g. the letter "A" or the symbol "@") causes that character value to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key.
- A hexadecimal value in the format \uXXXXXX (e.g. \u000001) causes the specified key code to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key. Allowable values can be determined from the Android documentation: https://developer.android.com/reference/android/view/KeyEvent.
- The value \EMOJI causes the remapped key to switch to the EMOJI keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbRemapNumericP4
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Remap Symbol P1
Enter a value that defines the behavior the Enterprise Keyboard on a device will perform when the Symbol P1 Key (located on the Symbol keyboard at Row 4, Column 1) is pressed.
Possible values can be: - A single character value (e.g. the letter "A" or the symbol "@") causes that character value to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key.
- A hexadecimal value in the format \uXXXXXX (e.g. \u000001) causes the specified key code to be sent as the behavior for the remapped key. Allowable values can be determined from the Android documentation: https://developer.android.com/reference/android/view/KeyEvent.
- The value \EMOJI causes the remapped key to switch to the EMOJI keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = ekbRemapSymbolP1
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Enterprise NFC Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Reset to Defaults, Logging, Type A Tags, Type B Tags, Type F Tags, Type V Tags, Use NFC Data Exchange Format (NDEF), Polling Mode, CPU Boost, Type A Tag Baud Rate, Type B Tag Baud Rate, Peer to Peer Mode, Card Emulation Mode, Power, and Use on Lock Screen.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Reset to Defaults
Select whether the Enterprise NFC settings should all be reset to their default values.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcResetToDefaults
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do Not Reset | false |
Reset | true |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Logging
Select whether logging should be used by Enterprise NFC
If the value Off is selected, Enterprise NFC will NOT capture logs.
If the value On is selected, Enterprise NFC will capture logs.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcDebugLogging
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | false |
On | true |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.3.
Type A Tags
Select whether the Enterprise NFC should read NFC Type A Tags.
If the value Do Not Read is selected, Enterprise NFC will NOT attempt to read NFC Type A Tags. This could increase the speed of reading other tag types in cases where Type A Tags are not used.
If the value Read is selected, Enterprise NFC will attempt to read NFC Type A Tags. This might decrease the speed of reading tags unless reading of other tag types is turned off.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcReadTypeATags
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do Not Read | false |
Read | true |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Type B Tags
Select whether the Enterprise NFC should read NFC Type B Tags.
If the value Do Not Read is selected, Enterprise NFC will NOT attempt to read NFC Type B Tags. This could increase the speed of reading other tag types in cases where Type B Tags are not used.
If the value Read is selected, Enterprise NFC will attempt to read NFC Type B Tags. This might decrease the speed of reading tags unless reading of other tag types is turned off.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcReadTypeBTags
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do Not Read | false |
Read | true |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Type F Tags
Select whether the Enterprise NFC should read NFC Type F Tags.
If the value Do Not Read is selected, Enterprise NFC will NOT attempt to read NFC Type F Tags. This could increase the speed of reading other tag types in cases where Type F Tags are not used.
If the value Read is selected, Enterprise NFC will attempt to read NFC Type F Tags. This might decrease the speed of reading tags unless reading of other tag types is turned off.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcReadTypeFTags
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do Not Read | false |
Read | true |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Type V Tags
Select whether the Enterprise NFC should read NFC Type V Tags.
If the value Do Not Read is selected, Enterprise NFC will NOT attempt to read NFC Type V Tags. This could increase the speed of reading other tag types in cases where Type V Tags are not used.
If the value Read is selected, Enterprise NFC will attempt to read NFC Type V Tags. This might decrease the speed of reading tags unless reading of other tag types is turned off.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcReadTypeVTags
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do Not Read | false |
Read | true |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Use NFC Data Exchange Format (NDEF)
Select whether the Enterprise NFC should use NFC Data Exchange Format (NDEF).
If the value Do Not Use is selected, Enterprise NFC will NOT attempt tp read NDEF formatted tags. This could increase the speed of reading non-NDEF tags by not spending unnecessary time trying to interpret tag data according to NDEF formatting rules.
If the value Use is selected, Enterprise NFC will attempt to read NDEF formatted tags. This may decrease speed somewhat, compared to reading unformatted tags, but increases flexibility by allowing applications to receive tag data interpreted according to NDEF formatting rules. Starting in Android 11, support for NFC Data Exchange Format (NDEF) is deprecated.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcUseNDEF
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do Not Use | false |
Use | true |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Polling Mode
Select the Enterprise NFC Polling Mode that should be used.
If the value Hybrid is selected, Enterprise NFC will poll in a manner designed to strike a reasonable balance between polling speed and battery life.
If the value Standard is selected, then Enterprise NFC will poll in a manner designed to maximize polling speed. This may increase battery drain but will reduce tag detection time.
If the value Low Power is selected, Enterprise NFC will poll in a manner designed to minimize impact on battery life. This may increase the overall tag detection time, but will reduce battery drain.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcPollingMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Hybrid | 2 |
Standard | 1 |
Low Power | 0 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
CPU Boost
Select whether the Enterprise NFC should Boost CPU Speed during NFC transactions.
- If the value Do Not Boost is selected, Enterprise NFC will leave the CPU Speed unmodified during NFC transactions.
- If the value Boost is selected, Enterprise NFC will Boost the CPU Speed during NFC transactions to enhance performance of those transactions.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcCpuBoost
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do Not Boost | false |
Boost | true |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Type A Tag Baud Rate
Select the Baud Rate that Enterprise NFC should use for Type A Tags.
- If the value 106 kbps is selected, Enterprise NFC will always communicate to Type A Tags using a Baud Rate of 106 kbps.
- If the value 212 kbps is selected, Enterprise NFC will communicate to Type A Tags using a Baud Rate of 106 kbps or 212 kbps, depending on the Baud Rate supported by the tag.
- If the value 424 kbps is selected, Enterprise NFC will communicate to Type A Tags using a Baud Rate of 106 kbps, 212 kbps, or 424 kbps, depending on the Baud Rate supported by the tag.
- If the value Any is selected, Enterprise NFC will communicate to Type A Tags using any available (automatically selected) Baud Rate supported by the tag.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcTypeABaudRate
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
106 kbps | 1 |
212 kbps | 16 |
424 kbps | 32 |
Any | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Type B Tag Baud Rate
Select the Baud Rate that Enterprise NFC should use for Type B Tags.
If the value 106 kbps is selected, Enterprise NFC will always communicate to Type B Tags using a Baud Rate of 106 kbps.
If the value 212 kbps is selected, Enterprise NFC will communicate to Type B Tags using a Baud Rate of 106 kbps or 212 kbps, depending on the Baud Rate supported by the tag.
If the value 424 kbps is selected, Enterprise NFC will communicate to Type B Tags using a Baud Rate of 106 kbps, 212 kbps, or 424 kbps, depending on the Baud Rate supported by the tag.
If the value Any is selected, Enterprise NFC will communicate to Type B Tags using any available (automatically selected) Baud Rate supported by the tag.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcTypeBBaudRate
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
106 kbps | 4 |
212 kbps | 64 |
424 kbps | 128 |
Any | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Peer to Peer Mode
Select whether the Enterprise NFC should use Peer to Peer Mode. This is generally used when two NFC enabled devices want to communicate with each other to exchange data.
- If the value Do Not Use is selected, Enterprise NFC will NOT use Peer-to-Peer Mode and hence will operate only in Read/Write Mode, unless it is also configured to operated in Card Emulation Mode by via Card Emulation Mode.
- If the value Use is selected, Enterprise NFC will use Peer-to-Peer Mode and hence will operate in both Peer-to-Peer Mode and Read/Write Mode, and and optionally also in Card Emulation Mode, if configured via Card Emulation Mode. Starting in Android 11, support for Peer-to-Peer Mode is deprecated.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcPeerToPeerMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do Not Use | false |
Use | true |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Card Emulation Mode
Select whether the Enterprise NFC should use Card Emulation Mode.
- If the value Do Not Use is selected, Enterprise NFC will NOT use Card Emulation Mode and hence will operate only in Read/Write Mode, unless it is also configured to operated in Peer-to-Peer Mode by via Peer to Peer Mode.
- If the value Use is selected, Enterprise NFC will use Card Emulation Mode and hence will operate in both Card Emulation Mode and Read/Write Mode and optionally also in Peer-to-Peer Mode, if configured via Peer to Peer Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcCardEmulationMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Do Not Use | false |
Use | true |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Power
Select whether the Enterprise NFC should be turned on or turned off
If the value Turn Off is selected, Enterprise NFC will be turned off.
If the value Turn On is selected, Enterprise NFC will be turned on.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcPower
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Turn On | 1 |
Turn Off | 2 |
Support Information:
- NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Use on Lock Screen
Select whether the Enterprise NFC should be allowed to be used from the Lock Screen.
If the value Disallow is selected, Enterprise NFC will NOT allow NFC operations to be performed when the device is at the lock screen.
If the value Allow is selected, Enterprise NFC will allow NFC operations to be performed when the device is at the lock screen.
Detail Information:
Key = nfcUseOnLockScreen
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | false |
Allow | true |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Ethernet Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Power, Control by User, Use Proxy Server, Proxy Server, Port, Bypass List, IP Address Type, IP Address, Gateway Address, Network Mask, Primary DNS, and Secondary DNS.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
Power
Select the Power State of the Ethernet Adapter.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetPower
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Control by User
Select whether Ethernet Power control by the device user will be allowed or not.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetPowerControlByUser
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Use Proxy Server
Select whether a Proxy Server should be used to access the Internet from the network accessed via the Ethernet Adapter.
When specifying that a Proxy Server is to be used, you should specify Proxy Server, Port, and Bypass List together whenever Ethernet Proxy Server configuration is performed to help ensure that all three three values are properly synchronized.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetUseProxyServer
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Use a Proxy Server | 2 |
Do NOT Use a Proxy Server | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
Proxy Server
Enter the Proxy Server used to access the Internet from the network accessed via the Ethernet Adapter.
While it is not mandatory, you should specify Proxy Server, Port, and Bypass List whenever Ethernet Proxy Server configuration is performed to help ensure that all three three values are properly synchronized.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetProxyServer
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
Port
Enter the Port that will be used to reach the Proxy Server to access the Internet from the network accessed via the Ethernet Adapter.
You should specify Proxy Server, Port, and Bypass List whenever Ethernet Proxy Server configuration is performed to help ensure that all three three values are properly synchronized.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetProxyServerPort
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
Bypass List
Enter the Proxy Server Bypass List which specifies addresses that should bypass the Proxy Server used to access the Internet from the network accessed via the Ethernet Adapter.
While it is not mandatory, you should specify Proxy Server, Port, and Bypass List whenever Ethernet Proxy Server configuration is performed to help ensure that all three three values are properly synchronized.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetProxyServerBypassList
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
IP Address Type
Select how an IP Address will be assigned to the Ethernet adapter.
- If the value Dynamic (DHCP) is selected, an IP Address for the Ethernet adapter will be automatically acquired by the DHCP Client from the DHCP Server.
- If the value Static (Manual) is selected, an IP Address for the Ethernet adapter will be assigned based on the values selected for IP Address, Gateway Address, Network Mask, Primary DNS, and Secondary DNS, which you must also specify to provide the required values.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetIpAddrType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Dynamic (DHCP) | 0 |
Static (Manual) | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
IP Address
Enter the IP Address to be assigned to the Ethernet adapter.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetIpAddress
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
Gateway Address
Enter the Gateway Address to be assigned to the Ethernet adapter.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetGatewayAddress
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
Network Mask
Enter the Network Mask to be assigned to the Ethernet adapter.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetNetMask
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
Primary DNS
Enter the Primary DNS Server Address to be assigned to the Ethernet adapter.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetDNS1
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
Secondary DNS
Enter the Secondary DNS Server Address to be assigned to the Ethernet adapter.
A given device may or may not support an Ethernet Adapter. An attempt to configure the Ethernet Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = ethernetDNS2
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
File Management
Use this Sub-group to configure Download File Source URI, Download Destination Path and File Name, Delete Path and File Name, Upload Source Path and File Name, Upload File Destination URI, Upload File Target File Name Pattern, Upload Order, Upload Duplicate Handling, and Upload Delete Source After Upload.
Detail Information:
Key = filesStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 5.0.
Download File Source URI
Enter the Source URI of a File on a Server to be Downloaded to the Device File System. You must also specify Download Destination Path and File Name to identify the Path and File Name in the Device File System to which the File will be stored once it has been Downloaded.
Detail Information:
Key = filesDownloadSourceURI
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 5.0.
Download Destination Path and File Name
Enter the Destination Path and File Name of a File to be Downloaded from a Server to the Device File System when Download File Source URI is specified.
Detail Information:
Key = fileDownloadDestPathAndFileName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 5.0.
Delete Path and File Name
Enter the Path and optionally the File Name of a Folder or File to be Deleted from the Device File System.
To Delete a Folder, specify a value that ends in a forward slash (/) character and that specifies the full Path in the Device File System to the Folder to be Deleted.
To Delete a File, specify a value that ends with the File Name and Extension and that specifies the full Path in the Device File System to the File to be Deleted.
Detail Information:
Key = fileDeletePathAndFileName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 5.0.
Upload Source Path and File Name
Enter the Source Path and File Name (which may include wildcard characters), which identifies one or more Files to be Uploaded to a Server from the Device File System when Upload File Destination URI is specified.
Detail Information:
Key = filesUploadSourcePathAndFileName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.1.
Upload File Destination URI
Enter the Destination URI on a Server to which Files should be Uploaded from the Device File System. You must also specify Upload Source Path and File Name to identify the Source Path and File Name of the Files to be Uploaded.
Detail Information:
Key = filesUploadDestinationURI
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.1.
Upload File Target File Name Pattern
Enter a Pattern to be used to construct the Target File Names of Files to be Uploaded to a Server from the Device File System when Upload File Destination URI is specified. The Pattern may contain any characters that are valid for use in a File Name on the Server, which may vary by Server but will generally include letters, digits, and a decimal point (dot) and may also contain one or more of the following:
- If the constant value %model% appears in the Pattern, then it will be replaced with the model name of the device.
- If the constant value %serial% appears in the Pattern, then it will be replaced with the serial number of the device.
- If the constant value %date% appears in the Pattern, then it will be replaced with the date the File was created in the Device File System.
- If the constant value %time% appears in the Pattern, then it will be replaced with the time the File was created in the Device File System.
For example, if the Pattern was "Log-%model%-%serial%-%date%-%time%.zip", a File that is Uploaded to the Server might be assigned the File Name "Log-TC51-123456789-041520-112300.zip", indicating that the File was a Log File that was Created on a TC51 device whose serial number was "123456789" and where the File was created on the device at 11:23 AM on April 15, 2020.
Detail Information:
Key = filesUploadTargetFileNamePattern
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.1.
Upload Order
Select the order in which Files will be Uploaded when Upload Source Path and File Name and Upload File Destination URI are specified.
- If the value Newest files first is selected, then the File with the newest creation date and time in the Device File System will be uploaded first, followed by the next newest, and so on.
- If the value Oldest files first is selected, then the File with the oldest creation date and time in the Device File System will be uploaded first, followed by the next oldest, and so on.
- If the value Sorted by filename is selected, then the File with the lowest alphabetically sorted File Name in the Device File System will be uploaded first, followed by the next lowest, and so on.
Note that for for best results, when Uploading multiple Files, the value Yes should be specified for Upload Delete Source After Upload. By Deleting Files from the Device File System as they are successfully Uploaded to the Server, errors can be more smoothly handled. For example, if a communications failure occurs during an Upload operation, causing it to terminate before sending all Files, then a subsequent Upload operation can pick up with the next File in the specified order. This is possible because Files that were previously Uploaded are no longer present to affect the Upload order.
Detail Information:
Key = filesUploadUploadOrder
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Newest files first | 1 |
Oldest files first | 2 |
Sorted by filename | 3 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.1.
Upload Duplicate Handling
Select how to handle the situation where an attempt is made to Upload a File to a Server when Upload File Destination URI is specified and the File Name to be Uploaded already exists on the Server.
- If the value Replace the file in the destination is selected, then the File will be Uploaded from the Device File System to the Server and will replace the existing File on the Server and the File WILL be deleted from Device File System if the value Yes is specified for Upload Delete Source After Upload.
- If the value Skip the file and remove from the source is selected, then the file will NOT be Uploaded from the Device File System to the Server and hence the original File will remain on the Server. Even though it was NOT Uploaded, the File WILL be deleted from Device File System if the value Yes is specified for Upload Delete Source After Upload.
- If the value Skip the file and keep it at the source is selected, then the file will NOT be Uploaded from the Device File System to the Server and hence the original File will remain on the Server and the File will NOT be deleted from Device File System even if the value Yes is specified for Upload Delete Source After Upload.
Detail Information:
Key = filesUploadIfDuplicate
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Replace the file in the destination | 1 |
Skip the file and remove from the source | 2 |
Skip the file and keep it at the source | 3 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.1.
Upload Delete Source After Upload
Select whether Files will be automatically Deleted from the Device File System after they have been successfully Uploaded to the Server.
- If the value No is selected, then Files will NOT be automatically Deleted from the Device File System after they have been successfully Uploaded to the Server.
- If the value Yes is selected, then Files will be automatically Deleted from the Device File System after they have been successfully Uploaded to the Server.
Detail Information:
Key = filesUploadDeleteAfterUpload
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
No | 0 |
Yes | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.1.
Firmware Over The Air Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure LifeGuard OTA Full Automation, LifeGuard OTA Options, LifeGuard OTA Service, LifeGuard OTA UI, Mode Manual Action, Enterprise Reset SUW Bypass, OS Upgrade Suppress Reboot, OS Streaming - Custom Authentication Header, OS Streaming - Password, OS Streaming - Username, OS Streaming - Zebra Authentication Token, OS Update/Upgrade/Downgrade File, and Verify Manifest File.
Detail Information:
Key = fotaStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.1.
LifeGuard OTA Full Automation
Select the state used to perform automatic updates on the device
- If the Mode value On is selected, OS update operations will be performed automatically as soon as new software is available.
- If the Mode value Off is selected, OS update operations will not be performed automatically even if new software is available.
Detail Information:
Key = OsAutoUpdate
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
On | 1 |
Off | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 11.1.
LifeGuard OTA Options
Enter one or more optional parameters to determine LifeGuard OTA behavior.
Detail Information:
Key = LifeGuardOTAOptions
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: Future Use.
LifeGuard OTA Service
Select the mode used to perform Firmware Over The Air (FOTA) operations on a device.
- If the Mode value Off is selected, Firmware Over The Air (FOTA) operations will be performed in Manual Mode only when Mode Manual Action is specified and when one or more of the following are specified: Enterprise Reset SUW Bypass, OS Upgrade Suppress Reboot, OS Update/Upgrade/Downgrade File, Verify Manifest File.
- If the Mode value On is selected, Firmware Over The Air (FOTA) operations will be performed in Automatic Mode you do not need to specify any additional information.
Detail Information:
Key = fotaMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
On | 1 |
Off | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.1.
LifeGuard OTA UI
Select whether the device user should be allowed to control the Mode of the LifeGuard Over The Air Client via the in-device Client UI.
Detail Information:
Key = fotaUserControlMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.1.
Mode Manual Action
Select an Action to perform in Manual Mode to explicitly perform a Firmware Over The Air (FOTA) operation on a device when the value Off is selected for LifeGuard OTA Service.
- If the value Enterprise Reset is selected, you may also specify Enterprise Reset SUW Bypass to control whether the Setup Wizard (SUW) will be bypassed on GMS devices following the Enterprise Reset.
- If the value Factory Reset is selected, you do not need to specify any additional information.
- If the value Full Device Wipe is selected, you do not need to specify any additional information.
- If the value OS Update is selected, you must also specify OS Update/Upgrade/Downgrade File to provide the path and file name of the image file (which must already be in the device file system at the specified location with the specified name) to be used to perform the operation.
Note that the Action value OS Update can be used to perform either an Upgrade or Downgrade operation on devices with Android versions < 8.0 but can only be used to perform an Upgrade operation on devices with Android versions >= 8.0. Furthermore, if the provided ZIP file attempts to do a Downgrade, the Downgrade will NOT occur on devices with Android versions >= 8.0.
- If the value Verify Manifest is selected, you must also specify Verify Manifest File to provide the path and file name of the Manifest file (which must already be in the device file system at the specified location with the specified name) to be used to perform the verification.
- If the value OS Upgrade is selected, you must also specify OS Update/Upgrade/Downgrade File to provide the path and file name of the image file (which must already be in the device file system at the specified location with the specified name) to be used to perform the operation. You may also specify OS Upgrade Suppress Reboot to control whether a reboot should automatically be performed following an A/B upgrade.
Note that the Action value OS Upgrade can only be used to perform an Upgrade operation on devices with Android versions >= 8.0. Furthermore, if the provided ZIP file attempts to do a Downgrade, the Downgrade will NOT occur.
- If the value OS Downgrade is selected, you must also specify OS Update/Upgrade/Downgrade File to provide the path and file name of the image file (which must already be in the device file system at the specified location with the specified name) to be used to perform the operation.
Note that the Action value OS Downgrade can only be used to perform a Downgrade operation on devices with Android versions >= 8.0. Furthermore, if the provided ZIP file attempts to do an Upgrade, the Upgrade will NOT occur.
- If the value OS Upgrade Streaming or OS Downgrade Streaming is selected, you must also specify OS Streaming File URL to provide the URL of the image file to be used to perform the operation.
- If the value Cancel is selected, if possible, the current operation is canceled.
Note that the Action value OS Upgrade Streaming or OS Downgrade Streaming can only be used to perform a streaming upgrade operation on devices with Android version >= 8.0
Detail Information:
Key = fotaAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Enterprise Reset | 5 |
Factory Reset | 6 |
Full Device Wipe | 7 |
OS Update | 8 |
Verify Manifest | 9 |
OS Upgrade | 10 |
OS Downgrade | 11 |
OS Upgrade Streaming | 12 |
OS Downgrade Streaming | 13 |
Cancel | 14 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Enterprise Reset SUW Bypass
Select whether the Setup Wizard (SUW) will be bypassed on GMS devices when performing an Enterprise Reset, when the Action value Enterprise Reset is selected for Mode Manual Action.
Detail Information:
Key = fotaActionEnterpriseResetSuwBypass
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Bypass | 1 |
Do NOT Bypass | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
OS Upgrade Suppress Reboot
Select whether the automatic reboot that would normally be performed following the successful completion of an A/B Upgrade should be suppressed, when the Action value OS Upgrade is selected for Mode Manual Action. Note that if the automatic reboot is suppressed, the reboot will still be required to activate the new OS following the A/B Upgrade, and the later performance of that reboot, at a suitable time, will become the responsibility of the EMM choosing to suppress the automatic reboot.
Note: This is not supported for differential or LifeGuard updates on devices running Android 10 or earlier, since they do not support A/B Upgrade.
Detail Information:
Key = fotaActionOsUpdateSuppressReboot
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Suppress | 1 |
Do NOT Suppress | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
OS Streaming - Custom Authentication Header
Enter all custom information to authenticate to the server to get access to the URL holding the OS or Patch image file to be used to perform a streaming update on a device when the Action value OS Upgrade Streaming is selected for Mode Manual Action.
Detail Information:
Key = fotaActionOsUpdateStreamingCustomAuthHeader
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
OS Streaming - Password
Enter the password associated with OS Streaming - Username to authenticate to the server to get access to the URL holding the OS or Patch image file to be used to perform a streaming update on a device when the Action value OS Upgrade Streaming is selected for Mode Manual Action.
Detail Information:
Key = fotaActionOsUpdateStreamingPassword
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
OS Streaming - Username
Enter the username to authenticate to the server to get access to the URL holding the OS or Patch image file to be used to perform a streaming update on a device when the Action value OS Upgrade Streaming is selected for Mode Manual Action.
Detail Information:
Key = fotaActionOsUpdateStreamingUserName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
OS Streaming - Zebra Authentication Token
Enter the token to use to authenticate to Zebra Support Central to get access to the URL holding the OS or Patch image file to be used to perform a streaming update on a device when the Action value OS Upgrade Streaming is selected for Mode Manual Action.
Detail Information:
Key = fotaActionOsUpdateStreamingZebraAuthToken
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
OS Update/Upgrade/Downgrade File
Enter the path and file name of an OS Update or Patch image file, which must already exist at the specified location in the device file system, to be used to update a device when one of the Action values OS Update, OS Upgrade, or OS Downgrade is selected for Mode Manual Action.
Detail Information:
Key = fotaActionOsUpdateFile
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Verify Manifest File
Enter the path and file name of a Manifest file, which must already exist at the specified location in the device file system, to be used to verify support on a device when the Action value Verify Manifest is selected for Mode Manual Action.
Detail Information:
Key = fotaActionVerifyManifestFile
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
General UI Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Action, Clear Application Cache Package, Clear Application Data Package, Allow device user Control of Do Not Disturb Mode, App Info Icon on Long Press on Recent App Header, Auto Correct, Battery Charging LED, Control Dark Theme, Display of Navigation Bar, External Keyboard, Launcher Package Name, Locale, Long Press on Home Key to Launch Google Assistant, Network Notification Popup, On-Screen Power Button, Pull Down Notification Bar, Show Airplane Mode in Power Key Menu, Show Battery Percentage In Notification Bar, Show Pairing Popup, Show Passwords, Show Touch Mode in Power Key Menu, Show Virtual Keyboard when Physical Keyboard is Active, Status Bar, Use Of Clipboard, Sharing, Use of Date in Notification Panel to Access Clock Application, Use of Home Key, Use of Magnification Gestures, Use of Recent Apps Key, Use of Split Screen Mode, User Control of Multi User, Touch Mode, Screen Protector, Turn on/off the Large Key Indicator feature, Device user control of Large Key Indicator, Assistant App, Home Screen Wallpaper, and Custom Home Screen Wallpaper.
Detail Information:
Key = uiStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.1.
Action
Select an Action to perform miscellaneous UI behavior on a device: - If the Action value Clear Clipboard is selected, any data currently in the clipboard of the device will be discarded, This will cause the data to no longer be available to paste.
- If the Action value Clear Recently Used Apps List is selected, the list of previously used (launched) applications will be cleared. This can be used to prevent the device user from accessing previously used applications or control their behavior or configuration from the list presented when the Recent button is pressed.
- If the Action value Clear Application Cache is selected, the cache of a specified application will be cleared. The most common use of this would be to delete cached information, such as login credentials or state, and thereby return the application to its default behavior. The use of this Action value requires that you must also specify Clear Application Cache Package to identify the application whose cache is to be cleared.
- If the Action value Turn On All GMS Applications is selected, all GMS applications that are considered Safe to Disable will be enabled.
- If the Action value Turn Off All GMS Applications is selected, all GMS applications that are considered Safe to Disable will be disabled.
Note: Since it is possible to turn GMS Applications on or off individually, using the values Turn On All GMS Applications and Turn Off All GMS Applications will guarantee only that all GMS Applications are On or Off immediately after the requested Action is completed. Subsequent Actions could result in any mixture of GMS Applications being turned On or Off. The behavior of the system or any GMS applications under such conditions is not guaranteed.
Detail Information:
Key = uiAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Clear Clipboard | 1 |
Clear Recently Used Apps List | 2 |
Clear Application Cache | 3 |
Turn On All GMS Applications | 4 |
Turn Off All GMS Applications | 5 |
Clear Application User Data | 10 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Clear Application Cache Package
Enter the Android Package Name for which the cache should be cleared by a Clear Application Cache Action when the value Clear Application Cache is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = uiActionClearApplicationCachePackage
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Clear Application Data Package
Enter the Android Package Name for which all user data should be cleared when performing a Clear Application User Data Action when the value Clear Application User Data is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = uiActionClearApplicationUserDataPackage
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Allow device user Control of Do Not Disturb Mode
Select whether the device user will be presented with the option to control the state of Do Not Disturb Mode from the Menu presented when the power key is held down on a device.
Detail Information:
Key = uiUserControlDoNotDisturbMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Hide | 2 |
Show | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
App Info Icon on Long Press on Recent App Header
Select whether a Long Press on the Home Key will Launch the Google Assistant.
- If the value Show is selected, an App Info Icon will be shown on Long Press on Recent App Header
- If the value Hide is selected, an App Info Icon will NOT be shown on Long Press on Recent App Header
Detail Information:
Key = uiAppInfoOnLongPressRecentAppHeader
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Show | 1 |
Hide | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.2.
Auto Correct
Select whether the device user prompted for corrections to potential mistakes made during entry of data on a device.
If the value Off is selected, the device user will NOT be prompted to correct potential mistakes during data entry.
If the value On is selected, the device user will be prompted to correct potential mistakes during data entry.
Detail Information:
Key = uiAutoCorrect
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Battery Charging LED
Select whether the charging system be allowed to display the battery charging state using the charging LED when a device is in operating mode.
- If the value Disable is selected, the charging system will be prevented from using the charging LED to display the battery charging state, which may reduce distractions in environments where many devices are charging.
- If the value Enable is selected, the charging system will be allowed to use the charging LED to display the battery charging state, which may make it easier to distinguish a fully charged device from a partially charged device.
Detail Information:
Key = uiBatteryChargingLED
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disable | 2 |
Enable | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Control Dark Theme
Select whether dark theme is used on the device.
- If the value Off is selected, dark theme is not used.
- If the value On is selected, dark theme is used.
Detail Information:
Key = uiDarkTheme
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 11.3.
Display of Navigation Bar
Select whether the on-screen Navigation Bar will be displayed and hence whether it will take up screen real estate and can be used to navigate the device UI.
- If the value Off is selected, the on-screen Navigation Bar will NOT be displayed and hence whether it will NOT take up any screen real estate, and hence cannot be used to navigate the device UI.
- If the value On is selected, the on-screen Navigation Bar will be displayed and hence whether it will take up any screen real estate, and hence be used to navigate the device UI.
Detail Information:
Key = uiDisplayNavigationBar
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
External Keyboard Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Action, Keyboard Name, Keyboard to remove, and Layout Name.
Detail Information:
Key = uiExternalKeyboardConfig
Type = bundle
Action
Select the External Keyboard Layout Mapping action to take.
If the value Add/Replace Keyboard Layout Mapping is selected, the external keyboard layout specified in Layout Name will be added or replaced for the keyboard name entered for Add/Replace Keyboard Name
If the value Remove Keyboard Layout Mapping is selected, the external keyboard layout associated with keyboard name Keyboard Name will be removed.
If the value Remove All Keyboard Layout Mappings is selected, all external keyboard layouts will be removed.
Detail Information:
Key = uiEKCAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Add/Replace Keyboard Layout Mapping | 1 |
Remove Keyboard Layout Mapping | 2 |
Remove All Keyboard Layout Mappings | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Keyboard Name
Enter the keyboard name to associate the layout being defined.
Detail Information:
Key = uiEKCName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Keyboard to remove
Enter the external keyboard name to associate the layout being added or replaced. This item is optional.
Detail Information:
Key = uiEKCOptionalName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Layout Name
Enter the keyboard layout name being defined.
Detail Information:
Key = uiEKCLayoutName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Launcher Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name of the default launcher application. This would typically be used when installing an new launcher (home screen) application as a replacement for the default Android launcher.
Detail Information:
Key = uiLauncherPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.1.
Locale
Select the Locale to be used on a device.
A Locale is typically specified by selecting a Language (e.g. English) and optionally a Region (e.g. the United States).
Values MUST specify a Language, and optionally a Region.
- When only a Language is to be specified, the identifier will be the name of the Language (e.g. CHINA).
- When both a Language and a Region are to be specified, the identifier will be the name of the Region followed by the name of the Language, separated by an underscore (e.g. CANADA_FRENCH).
Detail Information:
Key = uiLocale
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
CANADA | en_CA |
CANADA_FRENCH | fr_CA |
CHINA | zh_CN |
CHINESE | zh |
ENGLISH | en |
FRANCE | fr_FR |
FRENCH | fr |
GERMAN | de |
GERMANY | de_DE |
ITALIAN | it |
ITALY | it_IT |
JAPAN | ja_JP |
JAPANESE | ja |
KOREA | ko_KR |
KOREAN | ko |
PRC | zh_CN |
SIMPLIFIED_CHINESE | zh_CN |
TAIWAN | zh_TW |
TRADITIONAL_CHINESE | zh_TW |
UK | en_GB |
US | en_US |
SPANISH | es_ES |
US_SPANISH | es_US |
BRAZIL_PORTUGUESE | pt_BR |
PORTUGUESE | pt_PT |
AUSTRALIA_ENGLISH | en_AU |
INDIA_ENGLISH | en_IN |
SWEDEN_SWEDISH | sv_SE |
NORWAY_NORWEGIAN-BOKMAL | nb_NO |
FINLAND_FINISH | fi_FI |
DENMARK_DANISH | da_DK |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 5.1.
Long Press on Home Key to Launch Google Assistant
Select whether a Long Press on the Home Key will Launch the Google Assistant.
- If the value Allow is selected, a Long Press on the Home Key will Launch the Google Assistant.
- If the value Disallow is selected, a Long Press on the Home Key will NOT Launch the Google Assistant.
Detail Information:
Key = uiLongPressHomeLaunchesGoogleAssistant
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Allow | 1 |
Disallow | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.2.
Network Notification Popup
Select whether the Network Notification Popup will be presented to inform the device user that their network may be monitored.
- If the value Off is selected, the Network Notification Popup will NOT be presented, and hence the device user will NOT be notified that their network may be monitored, even if circumstances warrant such notification.
- If the value On is selected, the Network Notification Popup may be presented, and hence the device user may be notified that their network may be monitored, if circumstances warrant such notification.
Detail Information:
Key = uiNetworkNotificationPopup
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.1.
On-Screen Power Button
Select whether the On Screen Power Button feature will be turned ON or OFF. the On Screen Power Button feature allows a button to be displayed which allows the device user to turn the device off, similar to the operation of the physical power button (if any) and can be used to improve the user experience in cases where a physical power button is not present or is not convenient to use, such as when the device user is wearing gloves.
- If the value Disable is selected, the On Screen Power Button feature will be turned OFF and hence the on-screen power button will NOT be displayed.
- If the value Enable is selected, the On Screen Power Button feature will be turned ON and hence the on-screen power button WILL be displayed.
Detail Information:
Key = uiOnScreenPowerButton
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disable | 2 |
Enable | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Pull Down Notification Bar
Select whether the device user is allowed to Pull Down the Notification Bar to interact with notifications in the Notifications Panel.
- If the value Off is selected, the device user will NOT be allowed to Pull Down the Notification Bar, and hence will not be allowed to interact with notifications in the Notifications Panel.
- If the value On is selected, the device user will be allowed to Pull Down the Notification Bar, and hence will be allowed to interact with notifications in the Notifications Panel.
Detail Information:
Key = uiPullDownNotificationBar
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.1.
Show Airplane Mode in Power Key Menu
Select whether the device user will be presented with the option to control the state of Airplane Mode from the Menu presented when the power key is held down on a device.
Detail Information:
Key = uiShowAirplaneModeInPwrKeyMenu
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Hide | 2 |
Show | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Show Battery Percentage In Notification Bar
Select whether the battery percentage will be displayed in the notification bar.
Detail Information:
Key = uiShowBatteryPercentage
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Turn Off | 2 |
Turn On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.1.
Show Pairing Popup
Select whether a New Pairing Popup will be presented when an unpaired peripheral device attempts to establish a new Bluetooth pairing with a device.
- This option has no effect on existing pairings.
- This option does not prevent new pairings that are initiated from the device to the peripheral.
- This option does not prevent new pairings from being established based on configured Silent Pairing rules.
Detail Information:
Key = uiPairingPopup
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Show Passwords
Select whether passwords should be shown (displayed) when entered on the device or hidden (masked).
- If the value Off is selected, passwords will globally be hidden (masked) whenever they are being entered on the device.
- If the value On is selected, passwords will globally be shown (displayed) whenever they are being entered on the device.
Detail Information:
Key = uiShowPasswords
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Show Touch Mode in Power Key Menu
Select whether the device user will be presented with the option to control the state of the Touch Mode from the Menu presented when the power key is held down on a device.
Detail Information:
Key = uiShowTouchModeInPwrKeyMenu
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Hide | 2 |
Show | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.2.
Show Virtual Keyboard when Physical Keyboard is Active
Select whether the Virtual Keyboard will be shown when the Physical Keyboard is Active.
- If the value Off is selected, the Virtual Keyboard will NOT be shown if the device has a Physical Keyboard that is Active. This can help avoid the annoyance and confusing of using up screen real-estate to display an on-screen keyboard when the device user is using a Physical Keyboard to enter data.
- If the value On is selected, the Virtual Keyboard will be shown when data entry is in progress regardless of whether the device has an Active Physical Keyboard.
Detail Information:
Key = uiShowVirtualKeyboard
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Status Bar
Select whether the Android Status Bar should be displayed.
- If the value Hide is selected, the Android Status Bar will not be displayed, which also means that the device user will not be allowed to interact with notifications in the Notifications Panel.
- If the value Show is selected, the Android Status Bar will be displayed, which also means that the device user might be allowed to interact with notifications in the Notifications Panel.
Detail Information:
Key = uIStatusBar
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Hide | 2 |
Show | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.4.
Use Of Clipboard
Select whether the device user will be allowed to utilize the clipboard on a device to cut, copy, and paste text between applications.
Detail Information:
Key = uiUseOfClipboard
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.2.
Sharing
Select whether the device user will be allowed to utilize the clipboard Sharing on a device to share the contents of the clipboard.
Detail Information:
Key = uiUseOfClipboardSharing
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Support discontinued from: MX 11.0.
Use of Date in Notification Panel to Access Clock Application
Select whether the Date in the Notification Panel can be used to invoke the Clock Application.
- If the value Allow is selected, clicking the Date in the Notification Panel will invoke the Clock Application.
- If the value Disallow is selected, clicking the Date in the Notification Panel will NOT invoke the Clock Application.
Detail Information:
Key = uiDateInNotificationAccessClock
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Allow | 1 |
Disallow | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.2.
Use of Home Key
Select whether the device user will be allowed to utilize the Home Key on a device to leave the current context and return to the Home/Launcher screen.
- If the value Off is selected, the Home key will be ignored and will cause no action if it is pressed.
- If the value On is selected, the Home key will be honored and will cause device to go to the Home/Launcher screen when if it is pressed.
Detail Information:
Key = uiUseOfHomeKey
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Use of Magnification Gestures
Select whether the device user is allowed to Use Magnification Gestures.
- If the value Off is selected, the Magnification Gestures will be ignored and no action will be taken if they are used by the device user.
- If the value On is selected, the Magnification Gestures will be honored and appropriate action will be taken if they are used by the device user.
Detail Information:
Key = uiUseOfMagnificationGestures
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.0.
Use of Recent Apps Key
Select whether the device user is allowed to Use the Recent Apps Key to access recently launched applications.
- If the value Off is selected, the Recent Apps Key will be ignored, and hence the device user will not be allowed to access recently launched applications.
- If the value On is selected, the Recent Apps Key will be honored, and hence the device user will be allowed to access recently launched applications.
Detail Information:
Key = uiUseOfRecentAppsKey
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
Use of Split Screen Mode
Select whether Split Screen Mode is allowed to be used on the device.
- If the value Disallow is selected, the use of Split Screen Mode will be blocked on the device.
- If the value Allow is selected, the use of Split Screen Mode will be allowed on the device.
Detail Information:
Key = uiSplitScreenMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
User Control of Multi User
Select whether Primary device user is allowed to invoke UI to manage Multi User, including the ability to Create, Delete, and limit the actions of Secondary Users.
- If the value Disallow is selected, the Primary device user will not be allowed to manage Secondary Users, even if the device supports multiple users.
- If the value Allow is selected, the Primary device user will be allowed to manage Secondary Users, if the device supports multiple users.
Detail Information:
Key = uiUserControlMultiUser
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Touch Mode
Select the operational mode of the Touch Panel in selected devices: - If the value Stylus or Finger is selected, the Touch Panel will be configured to optimize use with a Stylus or an ungloved Finger.
- If the value Glove or Finger is selected, the Touch Panel will be configured to optimize use with a Gloved finger or an ungloved Finger.
- If the value Finger Only is selected, the Touch Panel will be configured to optimize an ungloved Finger.
- If the value Stylus or Glove or Finger is selected, the Touch Panel will be configured to optimize use with a Stylus, a Gloved finger, or an ungloved Finger.
- If the value Finger and Wet is selected, the Touch Panel will be configured to optimize use with a finger on a wet touch panel
Not all devices support the ability to configure the Touch Panel mode and those that do may not support every mode.
- An attempt to configure the Touch Panel mode on a device that does not support it will result in an error.
- An attempt to configure a Touch Panel mode on a device that does not support that mode will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = uiTouchMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Stylus or Finger | Stylus and Finger |
Glove or Finger | Glove and Finger |
Finger Only | Finger |
Stylus or Glove or Finger | Stylus and Glove and Finger |
Finger and Wet | Finger and Wet |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Screen Protector
Select whether Touch Panel should be optimized for use with a Screen Protector. - If selected, the Touch Panel will be configured to optimize use with a screen Protector.
- If unselected, the Touch Panel will be configured to optimize use without a screen Protector.
Not all devices support the ability to configure the Touch Panel to account for the use or a screen Protector.
Detail Information:
Key = uiTouchScreenProtector
Type = boolean
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Turn on/off the Large Key Indicator feature
Select whether the Large Key Indicator feature, which allows a large on-screen indicator to be displayed to indicate the state physical keypad on the device (if any) and which can assist the device user in cases where multiple key sequences are required.
- If the value Turn Off is selected, the Large Key Indicator feature will be turned OFF and hence the on-screen indicator will NOT be displayed.
- If the value Turn On is selected, the Large Key Indicator feature will be turned ON and hence the on-screen indicator WILL be displayed.
Detail Information:
Key = uiSetLKI
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Turn On | 1 |
Turn Off | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.0.
Device user control of Large Key Indicator
Select whether the device user will be allowed to turn the Large Key Indicator feature ON or OFF.
- If the value Enable is selected, the device user WILL be allowed to turn the Large Key Indicator feature ON or OFF.
- If the value Disable is selected, the device user will NOT be allowed to turn the Large Key Indicator feature ON or OFF.
Detail Information:
Key = uiUserControlLKI
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Enable | 1 |
Disable | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.0.
Assistant App
Select the assistant to use on the device.
- If the value Google Digital Assistant is selected, the Google Digital Assistant will be used
- If the value Custom assistant app is selected, the custom assistant app specified in Custom Assistant App will be used.
- If the value None is selected, no assistant app will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = uiAssistantApp
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Google Digital Assistant | 1 |
Custom assistant app | 2 |
None | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Support discontinued from: MX 11.0.
Home Screen Wallpaper
Select the assistant to use on the device.
- If the value Restore to default is selected, the default wallpaper will be used.
- If the value Custom is selected, the custom wallpaper specified in Custom Home Screen Wallpaper will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = uiHomeScreenWallpaper
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Restore to default | 1 |
Custom | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
Support discontinued from: MX 11.0.
Custom Home Screen Wallpaper
Enter the path and file name of an image file on the device (.jpg or .png)
Detail Information:
Key = uiCustomHomeWallpaper
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.5.
GMS Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure GMS Feature Set and GMS Profile.
Detail Information:
Key = gmsStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
GMS Feature Set
Select the amount of functionality of Google Mobile Services (GMS) to enable.
If the value All - Full Set of GMS Features is selected, the the entire set of Google Mobile Services (GMS), will be enabled for use. Note that if Google Mobile Services are allowed to be used, may collect and send data to Google.
If the value Restricted - Fixed Minimal Set of GMS Features is selected, a limited (fixed) subset of Google Mobile Services (GMS), will be enabled for use. The subset will automatically be chosen to ensure that basic device functionality is not impaired, that all enabled Google Mobile Services operate usefully, and that no enabled Google Mobile Services send any data to Google.
If the value Profiled - Selected Subset of GMS Features is selected, a selected subset of Google Mobile Services (GMS) features will be enabled for use.
Detail Information:
Key = gmsFeatureSet
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
All - Full Set of GMS Features | 1 |
Restricted - Fixed Minimal Set of GMS Features | 2 |
Profiled - Selected Subset of GMS Features | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
GMS Profile
Select the Google Mobile Services (GMS) profile to enable.
- If the value Chrome Browser is selected, Chrome Browser will be enabled for use. - If the value Google Maps is selected, Google Maps will be enabled for use. - If the value Firebase Cloud Messaging is selected, Firebase Cloud Messaging will be enabled for use. - If the value Combination of Chrome and Maps and FCM is selected, Combination of Chrome, Maps and FCM will be enabled for use.
Detail Information:
Key = gmsProfile
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Chrome Browser | 1 |
Google Maps | 2 |
Firebase Cloud Messaging | 3 |
Combination of Chrome and Maps and FCM | 4 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
GPRS Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Action, Add APN Name, Add APN Replace If Existing, Add APN Make Default, Add APN Access Point, Add APN User Name, Add APN Password, Add APN Port, Add APN Proxy, Add APN MMS Port, Add APN MMS Proxy, Add APN Server, Add APN MMSC, Add APN Type, Add APN MCC, Add APN MNC, Add APN Protocol, Add APN Roaming Protocol, Add Authentication Type, Add MVNO Type, Add MVNO Match Data, and Remove APN Name.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Action
Select an Action to manage the GPRS APNs on a device:
- If the value AddApn is selected, a new APN will be added, or an existing APN will be overwritten with a new APN. You must also specify Add APN Name to provide the name of the new APN to be added or the name of the existing APN to be replaced. In addition, you must also specify some or all of the following to provide the APN definition:
- Add APN Replace If Existing
- Add APN Make Default
- Add APN Access Point
- Add APN User Name
- Add APN Password
- Add APN Port
- Add APN Proxy
- Add APN MMS Port
- Add APN MMS Proxy
- Add APN Server
- Add APN MMSC
- Add APN Type
- Add APN MCC
- Add APN MNC
- If the value RemoveApn is selected, an existing APN will be removed. You must also specify Remove APN Name to provide the name of the APN to be removed.
- If the value RemoveAllApns is selected, all existing APNs will be removed and you do not need to specify any additional information.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
AddApn | 1 |
RemoveApn | 2 |
RemoveAllApns | 3 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Add APN Name
Enter the name of an APN to be added when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Add APN Replace If Existing
Select what happens when an APN already exists with the APN name being added when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
- If the value Replace Existing is selected, if an APN with the name specified via Add APN Name already exists, it will be replaced by the definition of the APN being added.
- If the value Keep Existing is selected, if an APN with the name specified via Add APN Name already exists, it will NOT be replaced. The existing APN will be preserved and the new APN will NOT be added.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnReplaceIfExisting
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Replace Existing | 1 |
Keep Existing | 0 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Add APN Make Default
Select whether a new APN being added should become the new default APN when the value AddApn is selected for Action. - If the value Yes is selected, the new APN being added will become the new default APN and will be preferred over other APNs when establishing a cellular data connection.
- If the value No is selected, the new APN will not become the new default APN and whatever APN was previously the default will remain the default.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnMakeDefault
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Yes | 1 |
No | 0 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Add APN Access Point
Enter a value that uniquely identifies an APN on the network when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
APN Identifiers are allocated by cellular carriers to identify the networks that can be reached via various APNs. When acquiring a cellular data plan from a carrier, an APN Identifier will be provided, typically along with other information that qualifies or controls access to the network it identifies.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnAccessPoint
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Add APN User Name
Enter a user name that can be used to authenticate to an APN when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
A network accessed via a given APN Identifier may or may not require authentication. If authentication is required, a user name is generally always required and a password MAY also be required.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnUserName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Add APN Password
Enter a password that can be used to authenticate to an APN when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
A network accessed via a given APN Identifier may or may not require authentication. If authentication is required, a user name is generally always required and a password MAY also be required.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnPassword
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Add APN Port
Enter the port number of an HTTP proxy to use for all traffic over the network accessed via an APN when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
If a Proxy is required, a Port is also generally always required.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnPort
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Add APN Proxy
Enter the address or name of an HTTP proxy to use for all traffic over the network accessed via an APN when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
- If a Proxy is required, a Port is also generally always required.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnProxy
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Add APN MMS Port
Enter the port number of an HTTP proxy to use ONLY for (Multimedia Messaging Service) MMS traffic over the network accessed via an APN when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
- If an MMS Proxy is required, an MMS Port is also generally always required.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnMmsPort
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Add APN MMS Proxy
Enter the address or name of an HTTP proxy to use ONLY for (Multimedia Messaging Service) MMS traffic over the network accessed via an APN when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
- If an MMS Proxy is required, an MMS Port is also generally always required.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnMmsProxy
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Add APN Server
Enter a WAP Gateway Server address that should be used for an APN when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
WAP Gateways are rarely, if ever, used on or supported by modern cellular carrier networks.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnServer
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Add APN MMSC
Enter the Multimedia Messaging Service Center (MMSC) address required to route MMS traffic over the network accessed via an APN when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnMmsc
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Add APN Type
Enter the Type of APN to be added when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
The value to specify for Type should be obtained from the cellular carrier whose network is to be accessed via the APN.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnType
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Add APN MCC
Enter the Mobile Country Code (MCC) of the APN to be added when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
The MCC generally match the SIM Card being used or the APN will not be usable.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnMcc
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Add APN MNC
Enter the Mobile Network Code (MNC) of the APN to be added when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
The MNC generally match the SIM Card being used or the APN will not be usable.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnMnc
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Add APN Protocol
Select the APN Protocol
- If the value IPv4 is selected, IPv4 will be applied
- If the value IPv6 is selected, IPv6 will be applied
- If the value IPv4/IPv6 is selected, IPv4/IPv6 will be applied
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnProtocol
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
IPv4 | 1 |
IPv6 | 2 |
IPv4/IPv6 | 3 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.3.
Add APN Roaming Protocol
Select the APN Roaming Protocol
- If the value IPv4 is selected, IPv4 will be applied
- If the value IPv6 is selected, IPv6 will be applied
- If the value IPv4/IPv6 is selected, IPv4/IPv6 will be applied
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnProtocolRoaming
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
IPv4 | 1 |
IPv6 | 2 |
IPv4/IPv6 | 3 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.3.
Add Authentication Type
Select the Type of Authentication to be used for APN to be added when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
- If the value None is selected, No Authentication Protocol will be used to authenticate for the APN.
- If the value PAP is selected, the Password Authentication Protocol (PAP) will be used to authenticate for the APN.
- If the value CHAP is selected, the Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol (CHAP) will be used to authenticate for the APN.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnAuthenticationType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
None | 1 |
PAP | 2 |
CHAP | 3 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.3.
Add MVNO Type
Select the MVNO (Mobile Virtual Network Operator) Type to be used for APN to be added when the value AddApn is selected for Action.
- If the value None is selected, No MVNO will be used to configured for the APN.
- If the value SPN is selected, the MVNO will be specified via an SPN (Service Provider Name) value for the APN, which you must also specify via Add MVNO Match Data.
- If the value IMSI is selected, the MVNO will be specified via an IMSI (International Mobile Subscriber Identity) value for the APN, which you must specify via Add MVNO Match Data.
- If the value GID is selected, the MVNO will be specified via an GID (Group Identifier) value for the APN, which you must specify via Add MVNO Match Data.
- If the value ICCID is selected, the MVNO will be specified via an GID (Integrated Circuit Card ID) value for the APN, which you must specify via Add MVNO Match Data.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnMvnoType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
None | 1 |
SPN | 2 |
IMSI | 3 |
GID | 4 |
ICCID | 5 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Add MVNO Match Data
Enter the MVNO (Mobile Virtual Network Operator) Match Data to be used for APN to be added when the value AddApn is selected for Action and if a value other than None is selected for Add MVNO Type.
The exact value to be specified depends on the MVNO Type specified. Consult your MVNO carrier for information on the MVNO Type and MVNO Match Data value to be used.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionAddApnMvnoMatchData
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Remove APN Name
Enter the name of an APN to be removed when the value RemoveApn is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = gprsActionRemoveApnName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.1.1.
Host Name Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Device Name.
Detail Information:
Key = hostStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.1.
Device Name
Enter the name by which a device will be known on the network.
Detail Information:
Key = hostDeviceName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.1.
Key Mapping Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Action, Add Mapping Key ID, and Add Mapping Behaviors.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Action
Select an Action to affect the behaviors mapped to the keys on the physical keyboard (if any) of a device:
- If the value Add Mapping is selected, a new mapping for a single physical key is added to the mapping tables for one or more keyboard states. You must also specify Add Mapping Key ID to provide the physical key for which mappings are to be added or replaced. In addition, you must also specify the Sub-array Add Mapping Behaviors to define the behavior(s) to be mapped to the identified physical key. If any prior mappings were applied to specify the behaviors of the identified physical key, they will all be replaced by the new specified behaviors.
- If the value Reset All Mappings is selected, the mapping tables are reset to their defaults. This effectively removes all mappings that have previously been added and returns the behaviors of all keys to their default out-of-box state.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Add Mapping | 1 |
Reset All Mappings | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Add Mapping Key ID
Select a value that uniquely identifies a physical key on the physical keyboard of a device for which one or more behaviors are to be specified when the value Add Mapping is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapActionAddMappingKeyId
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
0 | 0 |
1 | 1 |
2 | 2 |
3 | 3 |
4 | 4 |
5 | 5 |
6 | 6 |
7 | 7 |
8 | 8 |
9 | 9 |
A | A |
B | B |
C | C |
D | D |
E | E |
F | F |
G | G |
H | H |
I | I |
J | J |
K | K |
L | L |
M | M |
N | N |
O | O |
P | P |
Q | Q |
R | R |
S | S |
T | T |
U | U |
V | V |
W | W |
X | X |
Y | Y |
Z | Z |
. (Period) | DOT |
, (Comma) | COMMA |
* (Star) | STAR |
# (Pound) | POUND |
F1 | F1 |
F2 | F2 |
F3 | F3 |
F4 | F4 |
F5 | F5 |
F6 | F6 |
F7 | F7 |
F8 | F8 |
F9 | F9 |
F10 | F10 |
F11 | F11 |
F12 | F12 |
Enter | ENTER |
Up | UP |
Down | DOWN |
Left | LEFT |
Right | RIGHT |
NAV_OK | NAV_OK |
Escape | ESC |
Backspace | BACKSPACE |
Delete | DELETE |
Insert | INSERT |
Space | SPACE |
Return | RETURN |
Clear | CLR |
Field Exit | FIELD_EXIT |
Alt | ALT |
Control | CTRL |
Shift | SHIFT |
Func | FUNC |
Alpha | ALPHA |
CL | CL |
FN | FN |
Blue | BLUE |
Orange | ORANGE |
Grey | GREY |
Diamond | DIAMOND |
Green Dot | GREEN |
Red Dot | RED |
Volume Up | VOLUMEUP |
Volume Down | VOLUMEDOWN |
Scan | SCAN |
Grip Trigger | GRIP_TRIGGER |
Grip Trigger 2 | GRIP_TRIGGER_2 |
Button L1 | LEFT_TRIGGER_1 |
Button L2 | LEFT_TRIGGER_2 |
Button R1 | RIGHT_TRIGGER_1 |
Button R2 | RIGHT_TRIGGER_2 |
Left Trigger | LEFT_TRIGGER |
Right Trigger | RIGHT_TRIGGER |
Center Trigger | CENTER_TRIGGER |
Gun Trigger | GUN_TRIGGER |
Headset Button | HEADSET_HOOK |
Back | BACK |
Home | HOME |
Menu | MENU |
Recent | RECENT |
Search | SEARCH |
Keyboard Backlight | KEYLIGHT |
Display Backlight | LAMP |
Power | POWER |
P1 Button | P1 |
P2 Button | P2 |
P3 Button | P3 |
P4 Button | P4 |
P5 Button | P5 |
P6 Button | P6 |
W1 Button | W1 |
W2 Button | W2 |
Rear Button | REAR_BUTTON |
Left External Trigger | LEFT_EXTERNAL_TRIGGER |
Right External Trigger | RIGHT_EXTERNAL_TRIGGER |
Bluetooth Remote Trigger 1 | BLUETOOTH_REMOTE_TRIGGER_1 |
Bluetooth Remote Trigger 2 | BLUETOOTH_REMOTE_TRIGGER_2 |
Touch NAV_PAD | NAV_PAD |
Macro 1 | M1 |
Macro 2 | M2 |
Macro 3 | M3 |
Macro 4 | M4 |
Macro 5 | M5 |
Macro 6 | M6 |
Brightness Up | BRIGHTNESSUP |
Brightness Down | BRIGHTNESSDOWN |
Keyboard | KEYBOARD |
Keyboard Backlight Brightness Up | KEYLIGHTUP |
Keyboard Backlight Brightness Down | KEYLIGHTDOWN |
Rotate | ROTATE |
- (Minus) | MINUS |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Add Mapping Behaviors
Use this Sub-array to configure one or more Behavior(s).
Detail Information:
Key = keymapActionAddMappingBehaviors
Type = bundle_array
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Behavior
Use this Sub-group to configure Table Name, Type, Send Key Code, Alt, Ctrl, Fn, Shift, Send Trigger, Send Intent, Type, Action, Category, Package Name, Class, Data URI, Flags, MIME Type, Extra Name, Extra Value, and Launch Application Name.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehavior
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Table Name
Select the name of the table into which a specific behavior will be stored. Mapping tables are associated with keyboard states and are named based on the state key on the physical keyboard of a device that causes that keyboard state to be activated or deactivated.
Note that due to variations in keyboard size and layout, not all keyboard states may be supported on all devices or on all keyboard possible on any given device. Some or all of the following may values may be supported:
If the value Base is selected, the Base Mapping table will be selected. The Base Mapping table defines the behavior that will be performed for a physical key when it is pressed while no special keyboard state is active.
If the value Blue is selected, the Blue Mapping table will be selected. The Blue Mapping table defines the behavior that will be performed for a physical key when it is pressed in conditions where the Blue key has been used to activate the Blue keyboard state.
If the value Orange is selected, the Orange Mapping table will be selected. The Orange Mapping table defines the behavior that will be performed for a physical key when it is pressed in conditions where the Orange key has been used to activate the Orange keyboard state.
If the value Grey is selected, the Grey Mapping table will be selected. The Grey Mapping table defines the behavior that will be performed for a physical key when it is pressed in conditions where the Grey key has been used to activate the Grey keyboard state.
If the value Shift is selected, the Shift Mapping table will be selected. The Shift Mapping table defines the behavior that will be performed for a physical key when it is pressed in conditions where the Shift key has been used to activate the Shift keyboard state.
If the value Control is selected, the Control Mapping table will be selected. The Control Mapping table defines the behavior that will be performed for a physical key when it is pressed in conditions where the Control key has been used to activate the Control keyboard state.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTableName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Base | Base |
Blue | Blue |
Orange | Orange |
Grey | Grey |
Diamond | Diamond |
Shift | Shift |
Control | Control |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Type
Select the type of behavior that will be performed when a specified key is pressed while the keyboard state associated with the specified Mapping table is active.The following may values are supported:
- If the value Send Key Code is selected, the behavior performed when the specified key is pressed while the keyboard state associated with the specified Mapping table is active will be to send a specified key code. This performs Classic Keyboard Remapping, where the behavior of a key is changed to be the behavior of some other key, which may or may not be present on the physical keyboard. You must also specify Send Key Code to provide the key code that will be sent.
- If the value Send Trigger is selected, the behavior performed when the specified key is pressed while the keyboard state associated with the specified Mapping table is active will be to send a trigger signal. Trigger signals may be used to initiate various activities, such as barcode scanning, RFID reading, push to talk, etc. You must also specify Send Trigger to select which trigger signal will be sent,
- If the value Launch Application is selected, the behavior performed when the specified key is pressed while the keyboard state associated with the specified Mapping table is active will be to launch an application. You must also specify Launch Application Name to provide the Friendly Name of the application to be launched. Note that this is NOT the Android Package Name. To launch an application by its Android Package Name, the value Send Intent should be used.
- If the value Send Intent is selected, the behavior performed when the specified key is pressed while the keyboard state associated with the specified Mapping table is active will be to send and Android Intent, which might cause any number of possible results, depending on the nature of the intent configured to be sent. You must also specify some or all of the following to define the Android Intent to be sent:
- Type
- Action
- Category
- Package Name
- Class
- Data URI
- Flags
- MIME Type
- Extra Name
- Extra Value
Sending an Android Intent provides a very flexible way to specify the behavior to be performed for a key by invoking an application or service. As such, there are many options that control the nature of the intent that will be sent. It is generally recommended to fully understand the nature of the Android Intent to be sent before attempting to configure it as a key behavior. In many cases, the application or service to be invoked will define the nature of the intent is wishes to received and that definition can be used to drive the configuration.
- If the value Suppress Key is selected, NO behavior will be performed when the specified key is pressed while the keyboard state associated with the specified Mapping table is active. This provides a method to remap a key to do nothing.
- If the value Reset To Default is selected, the behavior performed when the specified key is pressed while the keyboard state associated with the specified Mapping table is active be reset back to its defaults. This will effectively remove any prior mapping of that key in that state and return the key to its standard behavior in that state.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Send Key Code | 2 |
Send Trigger | 1 |
Launch Application | 4 |
Send Intent | 3 |
Suppress Key | 5 |
Reset To Default | 7 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Send Key Code
Select the key code that will be sent as the behavior for a specified key a specified state when the value Send Key Code is selected for Type.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendKeyCode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
0 | 7 |
1 | 8 |
2 | 9 |
3 | 10 |
4 | 11 |
5 | 12 |
6 | 13 |
7 | 14 |
8 | 15 |
9 | 16 |
+ (Plus) | 81 |
- (Minus) | 69 |
= (Equals) | 70 |
( (Left Bracket) | 71 |
) (Right Bracket) | 72 |
` (Grave) | 68 |
/ (Slash) | 76 |
\\\\ (Backslash) | 73 |
; (Semicolon) | 74 |
' (Apostrophe) | 75 |
, (Comma) | 55 |
. (Period) | 56 |
* (Star) | 17 |
# (Pound) | 18 |
@ (At) | 77 |
A | 29 |
B | 30 |
C | 31 |
D | 32 |
E | 33 |
F | 34 |
G | 35 |
H | 36 |
I | 37 |
J | 38 |
K | 39 |
L | 40 |
M | 41 |
N | 42 |
O | 43 |
P | 44 |
Q | 45 |
R | 46 |
S | 47 |
T | 48 |
U | 49 |
V | 50 |
W | 51 |
X | 52 |
Y | 53 |
Z | 54 |
Enter | 66 |
Tab | 61 |
Space | 62 |
Escape | 111 |
Delete | 67 |
F1 | 131 |
F2 | 132 |
F3 | 133 |
F4 | 134 |
F5 | 135 |
F6 | 136 |
F7 | 137 |
F8 | 138 |
F9 | 139 |
F10 | 140 |
F11 | 141 |
F12 | 142 |
NUMPAD 0 | 144 |
NUMPAD 1 | 145 |
NUMPAD 2 | 146 |
NUMPAD 3 | 147 |
NUMPAD 4 | 148 |
NUMPAD 5 | 149 |
NUMPAD 6 | 150 |
NUMPAD 7 | 151 |
NUMPAD 8 | 152 |
NUMPAD 9 | 153 |
NUMPAD / (NUMPAD Divide) | 154 |
NUMPAD * (NUMPAD Multiply) | 155 |
NUMPAD - (NUMPAD Subtract) | 156 |
NUMPAD + (NUMPAD Add) | 157 |
NUMPAD . (NUMPAD Period) | 158 |
NUMPAD , (NUMPAD Comma) | 159 |
NUMPAD Enter | 160 |
NUMPAD = (NUMPAD Equals) | 161 |
NUMPAD { (NUMPAD Left Parenthesis) | 162 |
NUMPAD } (NUMPAD Right Parenthesis) | 163 |
DPAD Up | 19 |
DPAD Down | 20 |
DPAD Left | 21 |
DPAD Right | 22 |
DPAD Center | 23 |
Move Home | 122 |
Move End | 123 |
Page Up | 92 |
Page Down | 93 |
Insert | 124 |
Forward Delete | 112 |
Clear | 28 |
Lamp | 10024 |
Do Nothing | 10026 |
Blue | 10027 |
Orange | 10028 |
Grey | 10029 |
Diamond | 10039 |
Alt | 10030 |
Control | 10031 |
Shift | 10032 |
Keyboard | 10034 |
Touch Calibrate | 10035 |
Scan | 10036 |
Search Key | 10037 |
None | 10038 |
KeyLight | 10025 |
Keylight Up | 10040 |
Keylight Down | 10041 |
Left Shift | 59 |
Right Shift | 60 |
Left Alt | 57 |
Right Alt | 58 |
Left Control | 113 |
Right Control | 114 |
Meta Left | 117 |
Meta Right | 118 |
Caps Lock | 115 |
Num Lock | 143 |
Scroll Lock | 116 |
SysRq | 120 |
Break | 121 |
Function | 119 |
Back | 4 |
Forward | 125 |
Home | 3 |
Menu | 82 |
Settings | 176 |
Application Switch | 187 |
Calculator | 210 |
Explorer | 64 |
Envelope | 65 |
Bookmark | 174 |
Music | 209 |
Call | 5 |
End Call | 6 |
Microphone Mute | 91 |
Camera | 27 |
Search | 84 |
Contacts | 207 |
Calendar | 208 |
Volume Up | 24 |
Volume Down | 25 |
Volume Mute | 164 |
Brightness Up | 221 |
Brightness Down | 220 |
Power | 26 |
Sleep | 223 |
Wakeup | 224 |
Headset | 79 |
Push-to-talk | 228 |
Camera Focus | 80 |
Media Play/Pause | 85 |
Media Stop | 86 |
Media Next | 87 |
Media Previous | 88 |
Media Rewind | 89 |
Media Fast-Forward | 90 |
Media Play | 126 |
Media Pause | 127 |
Media Close | 128 |
Media Eject | 129 |
Media Record | 130 |
Button L1 | 102 |
Button R1 | 103 |
Button L2 | 104 |
Button R2 | 105 |
Button A | 96 |
Button B | 97 |
Button C | 98 |
Button X | 99 |
Button Y | 100 |
Button Z | 101 |
Left Thumb Button | 106 |
Right Thumb Button | 107 |
Start Button | 108 |
Select Button | 109 |
Mode Button | 110 |
Gamepad Button 1 | 188 |
Gamepad Button 2 | 189 |
Gamepad Button 3 | 190 |
Gamepad Button 4 | 191 |
Gamepad Button 5 | 192 |
Gamepad Button 6 | 193 |
Gamepad Button 7 | 194 |
Gamepad Button 8 | 195 |
Gamepad Button 9 | 196 |
Gamepad Button 10 | 197 |
Gamepad Button 11 | 198 |
Gamepad Button 12 | 199 |
Gamepad Button 13 | 200 |
Gamepad Button 14 | 201 |
Gamepad Button 15 | 202 |
Gamepad Button 16 | 203 |
Zenkaku/Hankaku | 211 |
Eisu | 212 |
Muhenkan | 213 |
Henkan | 214 |
Katakana/Hiragana | 215 |
Ro | 217 |
Yen | 216 |
Kana | 218 |
Keyboard | 10034 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Alt
Select how a key code will be sent as the behavior for a specified key a specified state when the value Send Key Code is selected for Type and when Send Key Code is specified.
- If the value Off is selected, when the key code is sent, it will be sent with the Alt keyboard state inactive. This will ensure that the key code is NOT interpreted as an Alt key.
- If the value On is selected, when the key code is sent, it will be sent with the Alt keyboard state active. This will ensure that the key code is interpreted as an Alt key.
- If no value is specified, when the key code is sent, the Alt keyboard state will not be changed. This will cause the key to be interpreted as an Alt key or not based on the existing state.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendKeyCodeAlt
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
On | 1 |
Off | 0 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Ctrl
Select how a key code will be sent as the behavior for a specified key a specified state when the value Send Key Code is selected for Type and when Send Key Code is specified.
- If the value Off is selected, when the key code is sent, it will be sent with the Ctrl keyboard state inactive. This will ensure that the key code is NOT interpreted as an Ctrl key.
- If the value On is selected, when the key code is sent, it will be sent with the Ctrl keyboard state active. This will ensure that the key code is interpreted as an Ctrl key.
- If no value is specified, when the key code is sent, the Ctrl keyboard state will not be changed. This will cause the key to be interpreted as an Ctrl key or not based on the existing state.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendKeyCodeCtrl
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
On | 1 |
Off | 0 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Fn
Select how a key code will be sent as the behavior for a specified key a specified state when the value Send Key Code is selected for Type and when Send Key Code is specified.
- If the value Off is selected, when the key code is sent, it will be sent with the Fn keyboard state inactive. This will ensure that the key code is NOT interpreted as an Fn key.
- If the value On is selected, when the key code is sent, it will be sent with the Fn keyboard state active. This will ensure that the key code is interpreted as an Fn key.
- If no value is specified, when the key code is sent, the Fn keyboard state will not be changed. This will cause the key to be interpreted as an Fn key or not based on the existing state.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendKeyCodeFn
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
On | 1 |
Off | 0 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Shift
Select how a key code will be sent as the behavior for a specified key a specified state when the value Send Key Code is selected for Type and when Send Key Code is specified.
- If the value Off is selected, when the key code is sent, it will be sent with the Shift keyboard state inactive. This will ensure that the key code is NOT interpreted as an Shift key.
- If the value On is selected, when the key code is sent, it will be sent with the Shift keyboard state active. This will ensure that the key code is interpreted as an Shift key.
- If no value is specified, when the key code is sent, the Shift keyboard state will not be changed. This will cause the key to be interpreted as an Shift key or not based on the existing state.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendKeyCodeShift
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
On | 1 |
Off | 0 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Send Trigger
Select the trigger signal that will be sent as the behavior for a specified key a specified state when the value Send Trigger is selected for Type.
Eight trigger signals are defined, but not all may be supported on all devices. All devices generally support at least Trigger 1 and generally default to using this trigger signal to activate the barcode scanner. Some devices may support additional trigger signals and some devices might be reconfigured to use Trigger 1 for some purpose other than barcode scanning. To determine which trigger signals are supported on a given device, consult the documentation for that specific device.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendTrigger
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Trigger 1 | 10016 |
Trigger 2 | 10017 |
Trigger 3 | 10018 |
Trigger 4 | 10019 |
Trigger 5 | 10020 |
Trigger 6 | 10021 |
Trigger 7 | 10022 |
Trigger 8 | 10023 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Send Intent
Select when an intent should be sent as the behavior for a remapped key.
- If the value On Key Down is selected, the intent will be sent immediately when the key is first detected as being pressed.
- If the value On Key Up is selected, the intent will not be sent until the key is detected as being released after being being pressed.
- If the value On Both Key Up and Down is selected, the intent will be sent immediately when the key is first detected as being pressed and then again when the key is detected as being released.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendIntent
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
On Key Down | 1 |
On Key Up | 2 |
On Both Key Up and Down | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Type
Enter the method in which an Android Intent should be sent to invoke an application or service when the value Send Intent is selected for Type.
Depending on the application or service to be invoked, there is likely only one method that can be used successfully to invoke a desired behavior in that application or service. You will need to consult the documentation or developer of a given application or service to determine whether a category value is needed and, if so, which value will invoke the desired behavior. The possible values are.
- If the value StartActivity is selected, the Android Intent will be sent using the startActivity() method. This method is suitable for invoking Activities, which are components that perform user interactions. If the behavior to be invoked involves interacting with the device user, this method will most likely be used.
- If the value Broadcast is selected, the Android Intent will be sent using the sendBroadcast() method. This method is suitable for invoking Services, which are components that implement background operations. If the behavior to be invoked does not involves interacting with the device user, this method will most likely be used.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendIntentType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
StartActivity | StartActivity |
Broadcast | Broadcast |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Action
Enter the action value of an Android Intent to be sent to invoke an application or service when the value Send Intent is selected for Type.
An action value is NOT mandatory to specify for an Android Intent. But an action value is commonly used to identify the purpose of an Android Intent. This can be especially when the application or service to be invoked supports multiple functions, in which case the action value is commonly used to identify which function to perform when invoking that application or service. You will need to consult the documentation or developer of a given application or service to determine whether an action value is needed and, if so, which value will invoke the desired behavior.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendIntentAction
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Category
Enter the category value of an Android Intent to be sent to invoke an application or service when the value Send Intent is selected for Type.
A category value is NOT mandatory to specify for an Android Intent. But a category value is commonly used to help identify the purpose of an Android Intent. This can be especially when the application or service to be invoked supports many functions, in which case many action values may be used to identify those functions and it may be useful to categorize those functions. In some cases, the same action value might be supported in more than one category. You will need to consult the documentation or developer of a given application or service to determine whether a category value is needed and, if so, which value will invoke the desired behavior.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendIntentCategory
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name of the application or service to invoke when the value Send Intent is selected for Type.
It is not mandatory to specify the Android Package Name when sending an Android Intent, but is is often advisable.
- When an Android Package Name is specified, the intent becomes an Explicit Intent and the intent can ONLY be sent to an application or service with that Android Package Name and no other. This can increase security and is often used when the intent being sent requires any sensitive data. You must also specify Class whenever an Android Package Name is specified, since an Explicit Intent is always sent to an Android Component, which is identified by a Android Package Name and a Class within that Package.
- When no Android Package Name is specified, the intent becomes an Implicit Intent and the intent may be sent to any application or service that has registered its ability to handle that intent. This can increase flexibility and is often used when the intent being sent requires no sensitive data and when it may be desirable to dynamically control which application or service is ultimately invoked to handle that intent.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendIntentPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Class
Enter the Android Class that identifies an Android Component within an application or service to invoke when the value Send Intent is selected for Type and when Package Name is specified.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendIntentClass
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Data URI
Enter a Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) that identifies some data, in the form of a resource on the device (e.g. a file in the device file system) or off the device (e.g. a resource available via a network) that should be utilized by the application or service invoked by the intent.
Whether the intended recipient of the intent expects a URI to be specified as part of the intent or not is up to that recipient and/or the definition of the intent that recipient is designed to consume.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendIntentDataUri
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Flags
Enter intent flags to be set for the intent to be sent.
Intent flags control how the intent is handled by Android. Some intent flags are specific to the type of component that will be invoked by the Intent (e.g. activity vs service). Whether certain intent flags are needed to produce the desired result when the intended recipient of the intent is invoked is up to that recipient and/or the definition of the intent that recipient is designed to consume. Intent flags MUST be specified as a hexadecimal value with the appropriate bits set for any flag or flags desired. Consult the Android documentation to translate intent flag names, when needed, into their appropriate hexadecimal values.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendIntentFlags
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
MIME Type
Enter a Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions (MIME) type to use when processing the intent data and when Data URI is specified.
Normally the type would be inferred from the data itself. Setting a MIME type explicitly, disables automatic type detection and and forces handling according to the specified type.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendIntentMimeType
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Extra Name
Enter the name of a single extra named string value to be attached to the intent to be sent.
Android allows a collection of extra named values, of various types, to be attached to an intent. Exactly one value whose data type must be string can be specified. When a name is specified, you must also specify Extra Value to provide the corresponding value to be attached for the string extra.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendIntentExtraName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Extra Value
Enter the value of the String Extra to be attached to the intent to be sent and whose name is specified via Extra Name.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeSendIntentExtraValue
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Launch Application Name
Enter the Friendly Name of an application to be launched when the value Launch Application is selected for Type.
Note that the application Friendly Name is NOT the same as Android Package Name. The application Friendly Name is generally the name by which the application is identified in in-device UI, such as the application Launcher, the application's Title Bar, and the list of application names display in the Recent Application list and the AppInfo section of the Settings UI. To launch an application based on its Android Package Name, the value Send Intent should be selected for Type instead.
Detail Information:
Key = keymapBehaviorTypeLaunchApplicationName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Notification Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Notification State and Notification Package Name .
Detail Information:
Key = notificationStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Android 11.
Supported from: MX 11.2.
Notification State
Select whether user notifications are on or off
- If the value Show For All Apps is selected, notifications for all applications will be shown to the user.
- If the value Hide For All Apps is selected, notifications for all applications will NOT be shown to the user.
- If the value Show By App is selected, notifications for the application defined in Notification Package Name will be shown to the user.
- If the value Hide By App is selected, notifications for the application defined in Notification Package Name will NOT be shown to the user.
Detail Information:
Key = notificationState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Show For All Apps | 1 |
Hide For All Apps | 2 |
Show By App | 3 |
Hide By App | 4 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Android 11.
Supported from: MX 11.2.
Notification Package Name
Select the Android Package Name that identifies the application for which notifications will be turned On or Off when Notification State is specified.
Detail Information:
Key = notificationPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Android 11.
Supported from: MX 11.2.
Permission Access Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Permission Access Action, Grant Permission, Grant Application Package, Grant Application Signature, Revoke Permission, Revoke Application Package, Revoke Application Signature, Ask Permission, Ask Application Package, and Ask Application Signature.
Detail Information:
Key = permissionAccessStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Permission Access Action
Select an Action to be performed to manage which Sensitive Android Permissions are allowed to be used by which applications.
If the value Grant is selected, then a Sensitive Android Permission will be Granted to a selected Application and you must also specify Grant Permission to identify the Permission to be Granted and you must specify Grant Application Package and Grant Application Signature to identify the Application to which the Permission will be Granted.
If the value Revoke is selected, then a Sensitive Android Permission will be Revoked from a selected Application and you must also specify Revoke Permission to identify the Permission to be Revoked and you must specify Revoke Application Package and Revoke Application Signature to identify the Application from which the Permission will be Revoked.
If the value Ask is selected, then the device user will be Asked whether a Sensitive Android Permission will be Granted or Denied to a selected Application and you must also specify Ask Permission to identify the Permission for which the device user will be Asked and you must specify Ask Application Package and Ask Application Signature to identify the Application for which the device user will be Asked.
Detail Information:
Key = permissionAccessAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Grant | 1 |
Revoke | 2 |
Ask | 3 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Grant Permission
Select the name of a Sensitive Android Permission to be Granted to a specified Application when the value Grant is selected for Permission Access Action.
Detail Information:
Key = permissionAccessActionGrantPermission
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Access Notifications | android.permission.ACCESS_NOTIFICATIONS |
Package Usage Stats | android.permission.PACKAGE_USAGE_STATS |
System Alert Window | android.permission.SYSTEM_ALERT_WINDOW |
Get AppOps Stats | android.permission.GET_APP_OPS_STATS |
Battery Stats | android.permission.BATTERY_STATS |
Manage External Storage | android.permission.MANAGE_EXTERNAL_STORAGE |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Grant Application Package
Enter the Android Package Name of an Application to which a Sensitive Android Permission should be Granted when the value Grant is selected for Permission Access Action.
Detail Information:
Key = permissionAccessActionGrantApplicationPackage
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Grant Application Signature
Enter the Android Package Signature of an Application to which a Sensitive Android Permission should be Granted when the value Grant is selected for Permission Access Action.
Detail Information:
Key = permissionAccessActionGrantApplicationSignature
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Revoke Permission
Select the name of a Sensitive Android Permission to be Revoked from a specified Application when the value Revoke is selected for Permission Access Action.
Detail Information:
Key = permissionAccessActionRevokePermission
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Access Notifications | android.permission.ACCESS_NOTIFICATIONS |
Package Usage Stats | android.permission.PACKAGE_USAGE_STATS |
System Alert Window | android.permission.SYSTEM_ALERT_WINDOW |
Get AppOps Stats | android.permission.GET_APP_OPS_STATS |
Battery Stats | android.permission.BATTERY_STATS |
Manage External Storage | android.permission.MANAGE_EXTERNAL_STORAGE |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Revoke Application Package
Enter the Android Package Name of an Application from which a Sensitive Android Permission should be Revoked when the value Revoke is selected for Permission Access Action.
Detail Information:
Key = permissionAccessActionRevokeApplicationPackage
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Revoke Application Signature
Enter the Android Package Signature of an Application from which a Sensitive Android Permission should be Revoked when the value Revoke is selected for Permission Access Action.
Detail Information:
Key = permissionAccessActionRevokeApplicationSignature
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Ask Permission
Select the name of a Sensitive Android Permission for which the device user will be Asked whether to Grant or Deny to a specified Application when the value Ask is selected for Permission Access Action.
Detail Information:
Key = permissionAccessActionAskPermission
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Access Notifications | android.permission.ACCESS_NOTIFICATIONS |
Package Usage Stats | android.permission.PACKAGE_USAGE_STATS |
System Alert Window | android.permission.SYSTEM_ALERT_WINDOW |
Get AppOps Stats | android.permission.GET_APP_OPS_STATS |
Battery Stats | android.permission.BATTERY_STATS |
Manage External Storage | android.permission.MANAGE_EXTERNAL_STORAGE |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Ask Application Package
Enter the Android Package Name of an Application for which the device user will be Asked whether to Grant or Deny a Sensitive Android Permission when the value Ask is selected for Permission Access Action.
Detail Information:
Key = permissionAccessActionAskApplicationPackage
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Ask Application Signature
Enter the Android Package Signature of an Application for which the device user will be Asked whether to Grant or Deny a Sensitive Android Permission when the value Ask is selected for Permission Access Action.
Detail Information:
Key = permissionAccessActionAskApplicationSignature
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Power Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Power Action, Battery Percentage Decommission Threshold, Battery Usage Decommission Threshold, Battery Critical Low Threshold, Battery Optimization Action, Add Package Names, Remove Package Names, Port Action, Port Select, Auto Power Control, Auto Power Off, Timeout, Auto Power On, Heater Action, Heater Select, Off Threshold, On Threshold, All Wake-up Sources State, Battery Saver Control Mode, Battery Saver Control Mode Automatic Percentage Threshold, Battery Saver Mode, Doze Mode State, User Control of Battery Saver Mode, Wake-up Source Key Identifier, Custom, Wake-up Source to Activate the Display State, and Wake-up Method.
Detail Information:
Key = powerStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Power Action
Select an Action to control the Power to the device.
If the value Sleep is selected, the device will go to Sleep (i.e. enter Suspend Mode).
If the value Reboot is selected, the device will perform an OS Reboot (i.e. simple Reset).
Detail Information:
Key = powerAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Sleep | 1 |
Reboot | 4 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.1.
Battery Percentage Decommission Threshold
Enter the percentage of remaining battery capacity below which the battery will be deemed ready for decommissioning.
Detail Information:
Key = powerBatteryThresholdPercentage
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Battery Usage Decommission Threshold
Enter the amount of battery usage (e.g. charge/discharge cycles, coulombs in/out, etc.) that can occur beefore the battery will be deemed ready for decommissioning.
Detail Information:
Key = powerBatteryThresholdUsage
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Battery Critical Low Threshold
Enter the threshold battery level below which the battery is deemed to be critically low.
- The Default Value is 4, which causes the battery to be deemed critical low when the battery level dips below 4% remaining capacity.
- If the value 0 is selected, the currently configured critically low threshold will not be changed, which is functionally equivalent to not specifying value.
- If a value from 1 through 25 will cause the critically low threshold will be set to the specified value.
Detail Information:
Key = powerBatteryThresholdCriticalLow
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Battery Optimization Action
Select an Action to control which applications are subject to battery optimization and which are exempt.
- If the value Add is selected, one or more applications will be made subject to battery optimizations and you must also specify Add Package Names to provide the Android Package Name(s) of the application(s) to be made subject to battery optimizations.
- If the value Remove is selected, one or more applications will be made subject to battery optimizations and you must also specify Remove Package Names to provide the Android Package Name(s) of the application(s) to be exempted from battery optimizations.
Detail Information:
Key = powerBatteryOptimizationAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Add | Add |
Remove | Remove |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Add Package Names
Enter one or more Android Package Name(s) that identify application(s) that should be made subject to battery optimizations.
- If specified, multiple Android Package Names should be separated using commas.
Detail Information:
Key = powerBatteryOptimizationActionAddPackageNames
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Remove Package Names
Enter one or more Android Package Name(s) that identify application(s) that should be exempted from battery optimizations.
If specified, multiple Android Package Names should be separated using commas.
Detail Information:
Key = powerBatteryOptimizationActionRemovePackageNames
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.0.
Port Action
Select an Action to control the Output Power various Ports on the device.
- If the value Turn Output Power OFF is selected, the Output Power for a specified Port will be turned off.
- If the value Turn Output Power ON is selected, the Output Power for a specified Port will be turned on.
You must also specify Port Select to provide the Port for which Output Power will be controlled.
Detail Information:
Key = powerPortAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Turn Output Power OFF | 2 |
Turn Output Power ON | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Port Select
Select the Port that will be affected by an Action to control the Output Power on the device when Port Action is specified.
- If the value Serial Port 1 is selected, the Output Power will be turned on or off for the first device Serial Port.
- If the value Serial Port 2 is selected, the Output Power will be turned on or off for the second device Serial Port.
- If the value USB Port 2 is selected, the Output Power will be turned on or off for the second device USB Port.
Detail Information:
Key = powerPortSelect
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Serial Port 1 | 1 |
Serial Port 2 | 2 |
USB Port 2 | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Auto Power Control
Select whether device power will be automatically controlled.
- If the value Off is selected, the device power will NOT be automatically controlled.
- If the value On is selected, the device power will be automatically controlled and you should also specify one or more of the following:
- Auto Power Off to specify whether/how device power will automatically be turned off.
- Auto Power On to specify whether/how device power will automatically be turned on.
Detail Information:
Key = powerAutoPowerControl
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Auto Power Off
Select whether and how device power will be automatically turned off as part of automatic power control when Auto Power Control is specified.
- If the value Never is selected, the device power will NOT automatically turn off when the ignition turns off.
- If the value When Ignition is Turned Off is selected, the device power will automatically turn off whenever the ignition turns off.
Detail Information:
Key = powerAutoPowerOff
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Never | 0 |
When Ignition is Turned Off | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Timeout
Enter the timeout that will be in effect before device power is automatically turned off as part of automatic power control, when the value On is selected for Auto Power Control is specified and the value When Ignition is Turned Off is selected for Auto Power Off.
Detail Information:
Key = powerAutoPowerOffTimeout
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Auto Power On
Select whether and how device power will be automatically turned on as part of automatic power control when Auto Power Control is specified:
- If the value Never is selected, the device power will NOT automatically turn on when the ignition turns on.
- If the value When Ignition is Turned On is selected, the device power will automatically turn on whenever the ignition turns on.
Detail Information:
Key = powerAutoPowerOn
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Never | 0 |
When Ignition is Turned On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Heater Action
Select an Action to control device heaters.
You must also specify Heater Select to identify the Heater to be affected.
- If the value Enable Heater is selected, the Heater will be be turned on and off as needed based on the configured ON/OFF thresholds.
- If the value Disable Heater is selected, the Heater will turned off and will stay off, regardless of the configured ON/OFF thresholds.
- If the value Set ON/OFF Thresholds is selected, the ON/OFF thresholds that will be used when the Heater is Enabled will be configured. You must also specify all of the following:
- On Threshold to set the threshold temperature below which the Heater will automatically be turned on.
- Off Threshold to set the threshold temperature above which the Heater will automatically be turned off.
Detail Information:
Key = powerHeaterAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Enable Heater | 1 |
Disable Heater | 2 |
Set ON/OFF Thresholds | 3 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Oreo and Pie.
Supported on Device(s): VC80X and VC8300.
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Support discontinued from: MX 9.0.
Heater Select
Select the Heater to be affected by a specified Heater Action when Heater Action is specified:
- If the value Serial I/O is selected, the Heater that warms the Serial I/O Port of the device will be selected.
- If the value USB I/O is selected, the Heater that warms the USB I/O Port of the device will be selected.
- If the value Battery is selected, the Heater that warms the Battery of the device will be selected.
- If the value Touch Panel is selected, the Heater that warms the Touch Panel of the device will be selected.
- If the value Keyboard is selected, the Heater that warms the Keyboard of the device will be selected.
- If the value Scanner Window is selected, the Heater that warms the Scanner Window of the device will be selected.
Detail Information:
Key = powerHeaterSelect
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Serial I/O | 1 |
USB I/O | 2 |
Battery | 3 |
Touch Panel | 4 |
Keyboard | 5 |
Scanner Window | 6 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Oreo and Pie.
Supported on Device(s): VC80X and VC8300.
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Off Threshold
Select the temperature above which a specified Heater should automatically turn OFF, when the value below which the specified Heater should automatically turn on is selected for Heater Action.
Detail Information:
Key = powerHeaterActionOffThreshold
Type = integer
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Oreo and Pie.
Supported on Device(s): VC80X and VC8300.
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
On Threshold
Select the temperature below which a specified Heater should automatically turn ON, when the value below which the specified Heater should automatically turn on is selected for Heater Action.
Detail Information:
Key = powerHeaterActionOnThreshold
Type = integer
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Oreo and Pie.
Supported on Device(s): VC80X and VC8300.
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
All Wake-up Sources State
Select whether all Wake-Up Sources will be enabled or not
- If the value Off is selected, the device will not have all the wake-up sources enabled - If the value On is selected, the device will have all the wake-up sources enabled.
Detail Information:
Key = powerAllWakeupSourceState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
Battery Saver Control Mode
Select how Battery Saver Mode will be activated (turned on) and deactivated (turned off) on the device.
If the value Automatically is selected, the device will activate (turn on) Battery Saver Mode automatically, and Battery Saver Control Mode Automatic Percentage Threshold must also be specified to provide the threshold battery level percentage below which the device will automatically activate Battery Saver Mode.
If the value Manually is selected, the device will NOT activate (turn on) Battery Saver Mode automatically, and will activate Battery Saver Mode only when specifically requested by the device user or by specifying the value Turn On for Battery Saver Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = batterySaverControlMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Manually | 2 |
Automatically | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.1.
Battery Saver Control Mode Automatic Percentage Threshold
Enter the battery level percentage below which Battery Saver Mode will automatically be activated (turned on) on the device when Automatically is specified for Battery Saver Control Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = batterySaverModePercentage
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.1.
Battery Saver Mode
Select whether Battery Saver Mode is active (turned on) or inactive (turned off) on the device when Manually is specified for Battery Saver Control Mode.
If the value Turn On is selected, then Battery Saver Mode will be activated (turned on) on the device.
If the value Turn Off is selected, then Battery Saver Mode will be deactivated (turned off) on the device.
Detail Information:
Key = batterySaverModeUsage
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Turn Off | 2 |
Turn On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.1.
Doze Mode State
Select whether Doze Mode will be globally used on the device.
If the value Off is selected, the device will never enter Doze Mode for any applications.
If the value On is selected, the device will will enter Doze Mode for various applications based on the normal Android rules for Doze Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = powerDozeModeState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.2.
User Control of Battery Saver Mode
Select whether the device user will be allowed to control the State of Battery Saver Mode via UI on the device.
If the value Disable is selected, then the device user will NOT be allowed to control the State of Battery Saver Mode via UI on the device.
If the value Enable is selected, then the device user will be allowed to control the State of Battery Saver Mode via UI on the device.
Detail Information:
Key = batterySaverUserControlOfMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disable | 2 |
Enable | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.2.
Wake-up Source Key Identifier
Select the Key Identifier of the Wake-Up Source to control
If the value L1 Button is selected, the device will use the First (Topmost) Button located on the Left side of the device for Display Wake-Up
If the value L2 Button is selected, the device will use the Second (Down from the top) Button located on the Left side of the device for Display Wake-Up
If the value R1 Button is selected, the device will use the First (Topmost) Button located on the Right side of the device for Display Wake-Up
If the value R2 Button is selected, the device will use the Second (Down from the top) Button located on the Right side of the device for Display Wake-Up
If the value Grip (Gun) Trigger is selected, the device will use the Trigger on the Grip (Gun Handle) for Display Wake-Up
If the value Rear Button is selected, the device will use the Button located on the Rear of the device for Display Wake-Up
If the value Custom is selected, the device will use a Custom Button for Display Wake-Up
Detail Information:
Key = powerWakeupKeyId
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Button L1 | BUTTON_L1 |
Button L2 | BUTTON_L2 |
Button R1 | BUTTON_R1 |
Button R2 | BUTTON_R2 |
Grip (Gun) Trigger | GUN_TRIGGER |
Rear Button | REAR_BUTTON |
Custom | Custom |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
Custom
Enter the Custom name of the key identifier of the Wake-Up Source to control
Detail Information:
Key = powerWakeupKeyIdCustom
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
Wake-up Source to Activate the Display State
Select whether to turn on or off the ability of a Wake-up Source to activate the display
- If the value Off is selected, the device will not have all the wake-up sources enabled - If the value On is selected, the device will have all the wake-up sources enabled.
Detail Information:
Key = powerWakeupDisplayState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
Wake-up Method
Select the Method that will be used to implement and control device Wake-up
- If the value Use Hardware Signals for Wake-Up is selected, the device will use hardware signals for wake-up - If the value Use Software (Mappable Keycodes) for Wake-Up is selected, the device will use software (mappable keycodes) for wake-up.
Detail Information:
Key = powerWakeupMethod
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Use Hardware Signals for Wake-Up | 1 |
Use Software (Mappable Keycodes) for Wake-Up | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.3.
Remote Scanner Management
Use this Sub-group to configure Action, Config Serial Number, Config File, Update Serial Number, Update File, Reset Serial Number, Page Serial Number, Disconnect Serial Number, and Unpair Serial Number.
Detail Information:
Key = remotescannerStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Action
Select an Action to control a Remote Scanner that isconnected to a device.
- If the value Apply Configuration Package(RS6000 only) is selected, a configuration file will be used to apply new configuration to a Remote Scanner. You must also specify Config Serial Number to provide the Serial Number that identifies the Remote Scanner to be configured. You must also specify Config File to provide the path and file name of the configuration file to be applied.
- If the value Update Scanner Firmware is selected, a firmware file will be used to update the firmware of a Remote Scanner. You must also specify Update Serial Number to provide the Serial Number that identifies the Remote Scanner to be updated. You must also specify Update File to provide the path and file name of the firmware file to be applied.
- If the value Reset Scanner(RS6000 only) is selected, a Remote Scanner will be reset, allowing errors to be cleared and proper operation of aRemote Scanner to be restored. You must also specify Reset Serial Number to provide the Serial Number that identifies the Remote Scanner to be reset.
- If the value Page Scanner(RS6000 only) is selected, a Remote Scanner will be paged, allowing a misplaced Remote Scanner to be more easily located. You must also specify Page Serial Number to provide the Serial Number that identifies the Remote Scanner to be paged.
- If the value Disconnect Scanner(RS6000 only) is selected, a Remote Scanner will be disconnected, terminating the connection between the device and the Remote Scanner and preventing its subsequent use. You must also specify Disconnect Serial Number to provide the Serial Number that identifies the Remote Scanner to be disconnected.
- If the value Unpair Scanner(RS6000 only) is selected, a Remote Scanner will be unpaired, terminating the pairing between the device and the Remote Scanner and preventing its re-connection without first repairing. You must also specify Unpair Serial Number to provide the Serial Number that identifies the Remote Scanner to be unpaired.
Detail Information:
Key = remotescannerAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Apply Configuration Package(RS6000 only) | 1 |
Update Scanner Firmware | 2 |
Reset Scanner(RS6000 only) | 3 |
Page Scanner(RS6000 only) | 4 |
Disconnect Scanner(RS6000 only) | 5 |
Unpair Scanner(RS6000 only) | 6 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Config Serial Number
Enter the Serial Number that identifies a Remote Scanner to which configuration should be applied when the value Apply Configuration Package(RS6000 only) is selected for Action. You must also specify Config File to provide the path and file name of the configuration file to be used.
Detail Information:
Key = remotescannerActionConfigSerialNumber
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.2.
Config File
Enter the path and file name of a configuration file, which must exist at the specified location in the device file system, from which configuration should be applied to the specified Remote Scanner when the value Apply Configuration Package(RS6000 only) is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = remotescannerActionConfigFile
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.2.
Update Serial Number
Enter the Serial Number that identifies a Remote Scanner for which a firmware update should be performed when the value Update Scanner Firmware is selected for Action. You must also specify Update File to provide the path and file name of the firmware file to be used.
Detail Information:
Key = remotescannerActionUpdateSerialNumber
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
Update File
Enter the path and file name of a firmware file, which must exist at the specified location in the device file system, from which firmware update should be performed to the specified Remote Scanner when the value Update Scanner Firmware is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = remotescannerActionUpdateFile
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
Reset Serial Number
Enter the Serial Number that identifies a Remote Scanner to be reset when the value Reset Scanner(RS6000 only) is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = remotescannerActionResetSerialNumber
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.2.
Page Serial Number
Enter the Serial Number that identifies a Remote Scanner to be paged when the value Page Scanner(RS6000 only) is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = remotescannerActionPageSerialNumber
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.2.
Disconnect Serial Number
Enter the Serial Number that identifies a Remote Scanner to be disconnected when the value Disconnect Scanner(RS6000 only) is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = remotescannerActionDisconnectSerialNumber
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.2.
Unpair Serial Number
Enter the Serial Number that identifies a Remote Scanner to be unpaired when the value Unpair Scanner(RS6000 only) is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = remotescannerActionUnpairSerialNumber
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.2.
RFID Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Country of Operation, Channel Mask, Channel Hopping, Action, Update Firmware File, Transmit Power Level, Query Select, Query Session, and Query Target.
Detail Information:
Key = rfidStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Country of Operation
Select the Country of Operation in which the RFID module will be used.
It is critical that the Country of Operation be set at least once, since the RFID module has no default Country of Operation and will not operate unless/until the Country of Operation is explicitly set, to ensure that country-specific regulator requirements are met.
In most cases, the Country of Operation will be set once and never changed, unless the device is physically relocated to a different country.
Detail Information:
Key = rfidCountryOfOperation
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
ALBANIA | 1 |
ANDORRA | 2 |
ARGENTINA | 3 |
AUSTRALIA | 4 |
BANGLADESH | 5 |
BHUTAN | 6 |
BOLIVIA | 7 |
BOSNIA_HERZENGOVINA | 8 |
BRAZIL | 9 |
CANADA | 10 |
CAMBODIA | 11 |
CHILE | 12 |
CHINA | 13 |
COLOMBIA | 14 |
DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC | 15 |
ECUADOR | 16 |
EL_SALVADOR | 17 |
UNITED_KINGDOM | 18 |
GUATEMALA | 19 |
GUAM | 20 |
HONG_KONG | 21 |
INDIA | 22 |
INDONESIA | 23 |
JAPAN_1W_LBT | 24 |
JAPAN_250MW | 25 |
LAOS_EU | 26 |
LAOS_FCC | 27 |
MACAU | 28 |
MACEDONIA | 29 |
MALAYSIA | 30 |
MEXICO | 31 |
MONACO | 32 |
MOTENEGRO | 33 |
NEW_ZEALAND_FCC | 34 |
NEW_ZEALAND_EU | 35 |
PAKISTAN | 36 |
PANAMA | 37 |
PARAGUAY | 38 |
PERU | 39 |
PHILIPPINES | 40 |
PUERTO_RICO | 41 |
RUSSIA | 42 |
SAUDI_ARABIA | 43 |
SINGAPORE | 44 |
SOUTH_AFRICA | 45 |
SOUTH_KOREA | 46 |
SRI_LANKA | 47 |
TAIWAN | 48 |
THAILAND | 49 |
TURKEY | 50 |
UAE | 51 |
UNITED_STATES | 52 |
URUGUAY | 53 |
VENEZUELA | 54 |
VIETNAM | 55 |
VIRGINIA_ISLAND | 56 |
ETSI 302.208 compliant generic | 57 |
FCC Part-16 compliant generic | 58 |
ISRAEL | 59 |
ALGERIA | 60 |
ARMENIA | 61 |
AUSTRIA | 62 |
AZERBAIJAN | 63 |
BAHRAIN | 64 |
BELGIUM | 65 |
BULGARIA | 66 |
COSTA_RICA | 67 |
CROATIA | 68 |
CYPRUS | 69 |
CZECH_REPUBLIC | 70 |
DENMARK | 71 |
EGYPT | 72 |
ESTONIA | 73 |
FINLAND | 74 |
FRANCE | 75 |
GEORGIA | 76 |
GERMANY | 77 |
GREECE | 78 |
HUNGARY | 79 |
ICELAND | 80 |
IRELAND | 81 |
ITALY | 82 |
JORDAN | 83 |
KAZAKHSTAN | 84 |
KUWAIT | 85 |
LATVIA | 86 |
LITHUANIA | 87 |
LUXEMBOURG | 88 |
MALTA | 89 |
NETHERLANDS | 90 |
NORWAY | 91 |
OMAN | 92 |
POLAND | 93 |
PORTUGAL | 94 |
QATAR | 95 |
ROMANIA | 96 |
SERBIA | 97 |
SLOVAKIA | 98 |
SLOVENIA | 99 |
SPAIN | 100 |
SWEDEN | 101 |
SWITZERLAND | 102 |
TUNISIA | 103 |
UKRAINE | 104 |
ANGUILLA | 106 |
MOROCCO | 107 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Channel Mask
Enter the Channel Mask that determines which of the Channels that are allowed, based on the currently selected Country of Operation will be used by the RFID module.
- If no Channel Mask is specified, the RFID module will be free to use any or all Channels that are available based on the currently selected Country of Operation.
- If a Channel Mask is specified, the specified value must consist of one or more Channel Numbers, separated by commas if more than one is specified, which identify the Channels that can be used. The RFID module will limit itself to just the Channels that are allowed for the currently selected Country of Operation AND that are in the set of Channels specified.
Consult the product documentation for the device being used to obtain the set of allowable Channel Numbers.
Detail Information:
Key = rfidCountryOfOperationChannelMask
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Channel Hopping
Select whether Channel Hopping will be performed among the Channels that are used by the RFID module.
Detail Information:
Key = rfidCountryOfOperationChannelHopping
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Action
Select an Action to alter the behavior or configuration of the RFID module.
- If the value Update Firmware is selected, the firmware of the RFID module will be updated and you must also specify Update Firmware File to provide the path and file name of the file, which must exist in the device file system, containing the firmware update to be applied to the RFID module.
- If the value Export Settings is selected, the current configuration of the RFID module will be exported and stored in a file in the device file system. This file could then be extracted from the device and used for troubleshooting potential configuration issues related to the RFID module.
- If the value Reset Radio is selected, the radio of the RFID module will be reset, without changing its settings. This could be used to recover from an error or other failure of the RFID module.
- If the value Reset Radio to Factory Defaults is selected, the configuration of the RFID module will be returned to its default out-of-box state and the radio will be reset. This could be used to recover from a serious configuration error that prevents the RFID module from functioning appropriately.
- If the value Update Firmware and Reset Radio to Factory Defaults is selected, the firmware of the RFID will be updated,l the configuration of the RFID module will be returned to its default out-of-box state, and the radio will be reset. This could necessary when applying a major new firmware update, that add lots of new configuration settings, to ensure that the RFID module is configured in a known and compatible state.
Detail Information:
Key = rfidAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Update Firmware | 1 |
Export Settings | 2 |
Reset Radio | 4 |
Reset Radio to Factory Defaults | 5 |
Update Firmware and Reset Radio to Factory Defaults | 6 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Update Firmware File
Enter the path and file name of the file containing the firmware update to be applied when the value Update Firmware or the value Update Firmware and Reset Radio to Factory Defaults is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = rfidActionUpdateFirmwareFile
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Transmit Power Level
Enter the RFID Power Level that should be used by the RFID module.
The RFID Power Level should be specified in tenths of dBm in the range of 0 to 300, inclusive.
For example, to specify an RFID Power Level of 29.5 dBm, specify a value of 295.
Detail Information:
Key = rfidTransmitPowerLevel
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Query Select
Select which RFID tags should be operated upon by the RFID module during a Query Operation, based on the state of the SL flag.
- If the value Query applies to all tags is selected, when the RFID module performs a Query Operation, it will consider all RFID tags that are currently visible to the RFID module.
- If the value Query applies to tags with SL de-asserted is selected, when the RFID module performs a Query Operation, it will consider only those RFID tags that are currently visible to the RFID module AND that have SL flag de-asserted (i.e tags for which the SL flag has NOT been set using the Select command).
- If the value Query applies to tags with SL asserted is selected, when the RFID module performs a Query Operation, it will consider only those RFID tags that are currently visible to the RFID module AND that have SL flag asserted (i.e tags for which the SL flag HAS been set using the Select command).
Detail Information:
Key = rfidQuerySelect
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Query applies to all tags | 0 |
Query applies to tags with SL de-asserted | 2 |
Query applies to tags with SL asserted | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Query Session
Select which Session should be used by the RFID module to access RFID tags during a Query Operation.
Allowable values are SessionS0, SessionS1, SessionS2, and SessionS3.
Sessions provide options for how to count tags. For more information on the use of Sessions, consult the device product documentation.
Detail Information:
Key = rfidQuerySession
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
SessionS0 | 0 |
SessionS1 | 1 |
SessionS2 | 2 |
SessionS3 | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Query Target
Select how the A and B flags of RFID tags should be handled by the RFID module during a Query Operation.
- If the value Inventory Target Flag A is selected, when the RFID module performs a Query Operation, it will consider only those RFID tags that are currently visible to the RFID module AND that are in State A.
- If the value Inventory Target Flag B is selected, when the RFID module performs a Query Operation, it will consider only those RFID tags that are currently visible to the RFID module AND that are in State B.
- If the value AB Flip is selected, when the RFID module performs a Query Operation, it will consider only those RFID tags that are currently visible to the RFID module AND that are in either State A or State B and will Flip the State from A to B or B to A for the session.
Detail Information:
Key = rfidQueryTarget
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Inventory Target Flag A | 0 |
Inventory Target Flag B | 1 |
AB Flip | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Security Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Action, Add Key Name, Add Key Value, Remove Key Name, Encrypt SD Card Key Name, Instant Screen Lock on Power Key, Screen Lock Type, and Screen Lock Timeout.
Detail Information:
Key = securityStep
Type = bundle
Action
Select an Action to adjust various security features on a device.
- If the value Add Key is selected, you must also specify Add Key Name to provide the name of the key to be added and you must also specify Add Key Value to provide the value of the key to be added.
- If the value Remove Key is selected, you must also specify Remove Key Name to provide the name of the key to be removed.
- If the value Remove All Keys is selected, you do not need to specify any additional information. Not supported on devices running Android 11 or later.
- If the value Encrypt SD Card is selected, you must also specify Encrypt SD Card Key Name to provide the name of the key to be used to encrypt the SD Card.
- If the value Wipe SD Card is selected, you do not need to specify any additional information.
Detail Information:
Key = securityAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Add Key | AddKey |
Remove Key | RemoveKey |
Remove All Keys | RemoveAllKeys |
Encrypt SD Card | EncryptSdCard |
Wipe SD Card | WipeSdCard |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Add Key Name
Enter the name of a key to be added when the Action value Add Key is selected for Action.
You must also specify Add Key Value to provide the value to be added for the specified key name.
Detail Information:
Key = securityActionAddKeyName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Add Key Value
Enter the value of a key to be added when the Action value Add Key is selected for Action.
You must also specify Add Key Name to provide the key name for which this value should be added.
A key value must be a string value containing exactly 64 hexadecimal characters ("0-9" and/or "A-F" characters) that encode a 256 bit binary value for an AES encryption key.
The key value can be generated in any manner desired as long as it is a 256 bit binary value and is represented as 64 hexadecimal characters, although in most cases, best practice would be to randomly generate keys to maximize their effectiveness in protecting data.
Detail Information:
Key = securityActionAddKeyValue
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Remove Key Name
Enter the name of a key to be removed when the Action value Remove Key is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = securityActionRemoveKeyName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Encrypt SD Card Key Name
Enter the name of a key to be used to encrypt the SD Card when the Action value Encrypt SD Card is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = securityEncryptSDCardKeyName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Instant Screen Lock on Power Key
Select what happens when the Power Key on the device is used to turn the device off, especially whether the device will be locked, requiring it to be unlocked by entering a PIN or password, if one is specified.
- If the value Off is selected, turning the device off using the Power Key will be handled the same as when the device times out and turns itself off automatically. In such a case, if device remains off for longer than value set via Screen Lock Timeout, when it is turned back on, the device will be locked, requiring whatever unlock action is set via Screen Lock Type.
- If the value On is selected, turning the device off using the Power Key will be handled differently than when the device times out and turns itself off automatically, specifically the device will become locked immediately when the device is turned off using the Power Key. In such a case, no matter how long the device remains off, when it is turned back on, the device will be locked, requiring whatever unlock action is set via Screen Lock Type.
Detail Information:
Key = securityPowerKeyInstantLock
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | Off |
On | On |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Screen Lock Type
Select the type of lock that is used to protect the device from use by unauthorized persons.
- If the value None is selected, no lock will be applied and the device can be used by anyone.
- If the value Swipe is selected, unlocking will require only a simple swipe and the device can be used by anyone.
- If the value PIN is selected, unlocking will require entry of a PIN (personal identification number) and the device can only be unlocked by someone knowing the correct PIN value.
- If the value Password is selected, unlocking will require entry of a password and the device can only be unlocked by someone knowing the correct password value.
- If the value Pattern is selected, unlocking will require drawing a pattern on the screen using the touch panel and the device can only be unlocked by someone knowing the correct pattern.
Detail Information:
Key = securityScreenLockType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
None | 5 |
Swipe | 1 |
PIN | 3 |
Password | 4 |
Pattern | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.0.
Screen Lock Timeout
Select what happens when a device turns off as a result of a timeout.
- If the device stays off for at least the time specified, the device will be locked and an unlock will be required when the device is turned back on, if any lock was configured using Screen Lock Type.
- If the device stays off for less than the time specified, the device will NOT be locked and hence no unlock will be required when the device is turned back on, even if a lock was configured using Screen Lock Type.
Detail Information:
Key = securityScreenLockTimeout
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Immediately after Display Timeout | 1 |
5 seconds after Display Timeout | 5 |
15 seconds after Display Timeout | 15 |
30 seconds after Display Timeout | 30 |
1 minute after Display Timeout | 60 |
2 minutes after Display Timeout | 120 |
5 minutes after Display Timeout | 300 |
10 minutes after Display Timeout | 600 |
30 minutes after Display Timeout | 1800 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.3.
Service Access Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Service Binding Action, Allow Service Identifier, Disallow Service Identifier, Service Caller Action, Allow Service Identifier, Allow Caller Package, Allow Caller Signature, Disallow Service Identifier, Disallow Caller Package, Disallow Caller Signature, Use CSP Action, Protect CSP Auto Approve, Protect CSP Name, Custom, Unprotect CSP Auto Unapprove, Unprotect CSP Name, Custom, Approve Caller Package, Approve Caller Signature, Approve CSP Name, Custom, Unapprove Caller Package, Unapprove Caller Signature, Unapprove CSP Name, Custom, Use CSP Function Group Action, Create Group Details, Create Group Name, Delete Group Name, Protect Auto Approve, Protect Group Name, Custom, Unprotect Auto Unapprove, Unprotect Group Name, Custom, Approve Caller Package, Approve Caller Signature, Approve Group Name, Custom, Unapprove Caller Package, Unapprove Caller Signature, Unapprove Group Name, and Custom.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceAccessStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Service Binding Action
Select an Action to allow or disallow Bindings to Zebra Value-Add Services, such as those that expose Privilege Escalation APIs, typically used by special purpose applications, such as Remote Control Clients.
To utilize Zebra Value-Add Services that expose APIs, an application must successfully create a Binding to the desired Service, after which it can make API calls via that Binding. Since the APIs provided by such Services enable applications that call them to perform sensitive operations, they should only be used by applications that you explicitly trust to use them safely.
By default, all Zebra Value-Add Services that expose APIs are configured to reject all Bindings. This ensures that the APIs exposed by such a Service cannot be used at all, unless you explicitly choose to allow use of specific Services.
Note that allowing Bindings to a Zebra Value-Add Service enables ALL applications to successfully initiate a Binding to that Service but does NOT enable ANY application to actually call the APIs exposed by that Service. To allow selected applications to call APIs on a Service for which Bindings are allowed, use Service Caller Action.
If the value Allow is selected, Bindings to a specifically identified Service will be enabled, potentially allowing the APIs of that Service to be called. You must also specify Allow Service Identifier to identify the Zebra Value-Add Service to which Bindings should be allowed.
If the value Disallow is selected, Bindings to a specifically identified Service will be disabled, preventing the APIs of that Service from being called. This is the default state for all Zebra Value-Add Services that provide APIs. You must also specify Disallow Service Identifier to identify the Zebra Value-Add Service to which Bindings should be disallowed.
Note that every Zebra Value-Add Service that exposes APIs will be identified by a unique Service Identifier, that identifies the Service when controlling access to that Service. Consult the documentation for a given Zebra Value-Add Service to determine its Service Identifier that you will need to identify that Service when controlling access to it.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceBindingAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Allow | 1 |
Disallow | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Allow Service Identifier
Enter the Service Identifier of a Zebra Value-Add Service when the value Allow is selected for Service Binding Action, to identify the specific Zebra Value-Add Service to which Bindings should be allowed.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceBindingActionAllowServiceIdentifer
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Disallow Service Identifier
Enter the Service Identifier of a Zebra Value-Add Service when the value Disallow is selected for Service Binding Action, to identify the specific Zebra Value-Add Service to which Bindings should be disallowed.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceBindingActionDisallowServiceIdentifer
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Service Caller Action
Select an Action to allow or disallow a specific application to call APIs exposed by a Zebra Value-Add Service, via a successfully established Binding.
Note that the default state for all Zebra Value-Add Services is for ALL applications to be disallowed from calling the APIs exposed by that Service. This ensures that no applications can call the potentially sensitive APIs exposed by a Service unless you explicitly choose to allow it.
Note also that since a Binding to a Service is required to call any APIs exposed by that Service, Bindings to a Zebra Value-Add Service MUST be allowed in addition to allowing specific applications to call the Service. Bindings to a Zebra Value-Add Service can be allowed via Service Binding Action.
If the value Allow is selected, a specifically identified application will be allowed to call APIs to a specifically identified Service. You must also specify Allow Service Identifier to identify the Zebra Value-Add Service to which API calls should be allowed and you must also specify Allow Caller Package and Allow Caller Signature to identify the application to be allowed to make API calls to the identified Service.
If the value Disallow is selected, a specifically identified application will be disallowed from calling APIs to a specifically identified Service. This is the default state for every Zebra Value-Add Service and for every potential calling application. You must also specify Disallow Service Identifier to identify the Zebra Value-Add Service to which API calls should be disallowed and you must also specify Disallow Caller Package and Disallow Caller Signature to identify the application to be disallowed from making API calls to the identified Service.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCallerAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Allow | 4 |
Disallow | 5 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Allow Service Identifier
Enter the Service Identifier of a Zebra Value-Add Service when the value Allow is selected for Service Caller Action, to identify the specific Zebra Value-Add Service to which API calls should be allowed.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCallerActionAllowServiceIdentifer
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Allow Caller Package
Enter the Android Package Name of an application that should be allowed to call APIs exposed by a Zebra Value-Add Service when the value Allow is selected for Service Caller Action, to identify the specific application that should be allowed to make calls to the Service identified by a specified Service Identifier.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCallerActionAllowCallerPackage
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Allow Caller Signature
Enter the Android Package Signature of an application that should be allowed to call APIs exposed by a Zebra Value-Add Service when the value Allow is selected for Service Caller Action, to provide the Android Package Signature of a specified application that should be allowed to make calls to the Service identified by a specified Service Identifier.
Note that the use of a Android Package Signature is MANDATORY and ensures that the application being allowed to make API calls to the specified Service is genuine and has not been spoofed. This prevents anyone from creating an impostor application with the same Android Package Name, but signed differently and then trying to make calls to the APIs of the Service as if they were the genuine application.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCallerActionAllowCallerSignature
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Disallow Service Identifier
Enter the Service Identifier of a Zebra Value-Add Service when the value Disallow is selected for Service Caller Action, to identify the specific Zebra Value-Add Service to which API calls should be disallowed.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCallerActionDisallowServiceIdentifer
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Disallow Caller Package
Enter the Android Package Name of an application that should be disallowed from calling APIs exposed by a Zebra Value-Add Service when the value Disallow is selected for Service Caller Action, to identify the specific application that should be disallowed from making calls to the Service identified by a specified Service Identifier.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCallerActionDisallowCallerPackage
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Disallow Caller Signature
Enter the Android Package Signature of an application that should be disallowed from calling APIs exposed by a Zebra Value-Add Service when the value Disallow is selected for Service Caller Action, to provide the Android Package Signature of a specified application that should be disallowed from making calls to the Service identified by a specified Service Identifier.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCallerActionDisallowCallerSignature
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Use CSP Action
Select an Action to Declare a CSP to be Protected or Unprotected and/or to make an application Approved or Unapproved to use a CSP that has been declared as Protected.
Note that the default state for all CSPs is Unprotected. This means that ALL CSPs can used by ALL applications. This ensures backward compatibility wherein any applications designed to use any CSPs will continue to be allowed to do so unless you specifically choose to prevent it.
To limit access to a CSP, the CSP must first be declared to be Protected. Once a CSP has been declared to be Protected, no applications will be allowed to use that CSP until they have been explicitly been Approved to use that CSP.
If the value Protect is selected, a specifically identified CSP will be declared to be Protected and hence will be limited to use by specifically Approved applications. You must also specify one of Protect CSP Name or Custom to identify the CSP to be declared Protected. You may also specify Protect CSP Auto Approve to automatically make OemConfig Approved to use that CSP.
If the value Unprotect is selected, a specifically identified CSP will be declared to be Unprotected and hence will no longer be limited to use by specifically Approved applications. You must also specify one of Unprotect CSP Name or Custom to identify the CSP to be declared Unprotected. You may also specify Unprotect CSP Auto Unapprove to automatically make OemConfig Unapproved from using that CSP.
If the value Approve is selected, a specifically identified application will be Approved to use a specifically identified Protected CSP. You must also specify one of Approve CSP Name or Custom to identify the CSP for which access is to be Approved. You must also specify Approve Caller Package and Approve Caller Signature to identify the specific application that will be Approved to use the specified CSP.
If the value Unapprove is selected, a specifically identified application will Unapproved from using a specifically identified Protected CSP. You must also specify one of Unapprove CSP Name or Custom to identify the CSP for which access is to be Unapproved. You must also specify one of Unapprove Caller Package and Unapprove Caller Signature to identify the specific application that will be Unapproved from using the specified CSP.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Protect | 1 |
Unprotect | 2 |
Approve | 4 |
Unapprove | 5 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Protect CSP Auto Approve
Select whether OemConfig should automatically be Approved to use the CSP being Declared as Protected when the value Protect is selected for Use CSP Action to Declare a CSP as Protected. This is a convenience to eliminate the need to separately make OemConfig Approved to allow it to use a CSP that has been Declared as Protected.
- If the value True is selected, the effect will be the same as if a Use CSP Action were with the value Approve to make OemConfig Approved to use that CSP. In most cases, it makes sense for OemConfig to be Approved to use any CSP that it used to declare to be Protected.
- If the value False is selected, the effect will be the same as if Use CSP Action was not used with the value Approve to make OemConfig Approved to use that CSP. This should be used with caution since if OemConfig is Unapproved from using any CSP that it has been used to declare to be Protected, any subsequent use of OemConfig that relies on that CSP will fail.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionProtectAutoApprove
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Approve | 1 |
Do Not Approve | 0 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Protect CSP Name
Select a standard CSP that will be declared as Protected when the value Protect is selected for Use CSP Action.
All standard CSP names are listed and can be picked from the list instead of having to enter them manually. This can help to avoid errors that could occur from mis-typing a CSP name. Custom could alternately be used in cases where typing in the CSP name is preferable.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionProtectCspName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
AccessMgr | AccessMgr |
AnalyticsMgr | AnalyticsMgr |
AppGalleryMgr | AppGalleryMgr |
AppMgr | AppMgr |
AudioMgr | AudioMgr |
AudioVolUIMgr | AudioVolUIMgr |
AutoTriggerMgr | AutoTriggerMgr |
Batch | Batch |
BatteryMgr | BatteryMgr |
BluetoothMgr | BluetoothMgr |
BrowserMgr | BrowserMgr |
BugReportMgr | BugReportMgr |
CameraMgr | CameraMgr |
CellularMgr | CellularMgr |
CertMgr | CertMgr |
Clock | Clock |
ComponentMgr | ComponentMgr |
ConditionMgr | ConditionMgr |
DevAdmin | DevAdmin |
DeviceCentralMgr | DeviceCentralMgr |
DisplayMgr | DisplayMgr |
EncryptMgr | EncryptMgr |
EnterpriseKeyboard | EnterpriseKeyboard |
EthernetMgr | EthernetMgr |
FileMgr | FileMgr |
GmsMgr | GmsMgr |
GooglePlayMgr | GooglePlayMgr |
GprsMgr | GprsMgr |
HostsMgr | HostsMgr |
Intent | Intent |
KeyMappingMgr | KeyMappingMgr |
LicenseMgr | LicenseMgr |
LifeGuardOTAManager | LifeGuardOTAManager |
NfcMgr | NfcMgr |
PersistMgr | PersistMgr |
PersonalDictionary | PersonalDictionary |
PowerKeyMgr | PowerKeyMgr |
PowerMgr | PowerMgr |
RemoteScannerMgr | RemoteScannerMgr |
RfidMgr | RfidMgr |
ScanModeMgr | ScanModeMgr |
SdCardMgr | SdCardMgr |
SettingsMgr | SettingsMgr |
Stats | Stats |
StatusMgr | StatusMgr |
ThreatMgr | ThreatMgr |
TouchMgr | TouchMgr |
UiMgr | UiMgr |
UsbMgr | UsbMgr |
Wi-Fi | Wi-Fi |
WirelessMgr | WirelessMgr |
WorryFreeWiFiMgr | WorryFreeWiFiMgr |
XmlMgr | XmlMgr |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Custom
Enter the name of a custom CSP that will be declared as Protected when the value Protect is selected for Use CSP Action.
Use when the CSP to be declared as Protected is not in the list of standard CSP names, such as when the CSP is a Plug-In CSP. Standard CSP names COULD be entered, but it would generally be preferable to use Protect CSP Name instead, since picking a name from a list is less error-prone than typing the name.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionProtectCspNameCustom
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Unprotect CSP Auto Unapprove
Select whether OemConfig should automatically be Unapproved from using the CSP being Declared as Unprotected when the value Unprotect is selected for Use CSP Action to declare a CSP as Unprotected.
This is a convenience to eliminate the need to separately make OemConfig Unapproved to remove it from the list of applications that are Approved to use a CSP that it has been used to declare as Unprotected. Strictly speaking, this is not mandatory, since once a CSP has been declared as Unprotected the list of applications that are Approved to use that CSP is no longer relevant. But since the list of applications that are Approved to use a CSP is preserved across declaring a CSP as Unprotected and then later declaring that CSP as Protected, it is good practice to clean-up the list to avoid unexpected behavior in the future.
If the value True is selected, the effect will be the same as if Use CSP Action were used with the value Unapprove to make OemConfig Unapproved to use that CSP. This will NOT result in OemConfig being unable to use the CSP since declaring the CSP as Unprotected explicitly allows ALL applications to use that CSP.
If the value False is selected, the effect will be the same as if Use CSP Action were not used with the value Unapprove to make OemConfig Unapproved to use that CSP. This would effectively clean-up the list and could avoid unexpected behavior in the future, should the CSP later be Protected again.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionUnprotectAutoUnapprove
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Unapprove | 1 |
Do Not Unapprove | 0 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Unprotect CSP Name
Select a standard CSP that will be declared as Unprotected when the value Unprotect is selected for Use CSP Action.
All standard CSP names are listed and can be picked from the list instead of having to enter them manually. This can help to avoid errors that could occur from mis-typing a CSP name. Custom could alternately be used in cases where typing in the CSP name is preferable.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionUnprotectCspName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
AccessMgr | AccessMgr |
AnalyticsMgr | AnalyticsMgr |
AppGalleryMgr | AppGalleryMgr |
AppMgr | AppMgr |
AudioMgr | AudioMgr |
AudioVolUIMgr | AudioVolUIMgr |
AutoTriggerMgr | AutoTriggerMgr |
Batch | Batch |
BatteryMgr | BatteryMgr |
BluetoothMgr | BluetoothMgr |
BrowserMgr | BrowserMgr |
BugReportMgr | BugReportMgr |
CameraMgr | CameraMgr |
CellularMgr | CellularMgr |
CertMgr | CertMgr |
Clock | Clock |
ComponentMgr | ComponentMgr |
ConditionMgr | ConditionMgr |
DevAdmin | DevAdmin |
DeviceCentralMgr | DeviceCentralMgr |
DisplayMgr | DisplayMgr |
EncryptMgr | EncryptMgr |
EnterpriseKeyboard | EnterpriseKeyboard |
EthernetMgr | EthernetMgr |
FileMgr | FileMgr |
GmsMgr | GmsMgr |
GooglePlayMgr | GooglePlayMgr |
GprsMgr | GprsMgr |
HostsMgr | HostsMgr |
Intent | Intent |
KeyMappingMgr | KeyMappingMgr |
LicenseMgr | LicenseMgr |
LifeGuardOTAManager | LifeGuardOTAManager |
NfcMgr | NfcMgr |
PersistMgr | PersistMgr |
PersonalDictionary | PersonalDictionary |
PowerKeyMgr | PowerKeyMgr |
PowerMgr | PowerMgr |
RemoteScannerMgr | RemoteScannerMgr |
RfidMgr | RfidMgr |
ScanModeMgr | ScanModeMgr |
SdCardMgr | SdCardMgr |
SettingsMgr | SettingsMgr |
Stats | Stats |
StatusMgr | StatusMgr |
ThreatMgr | ThreatMgr |
TouchMgr | TouchMgr |
UiMgr | UiMgr |
UsbMgr | UsbMgr |
Wi-Fi | Wi-Fi |
WirelessMgr | WirelessMgr |
WorryFreeWiFiMgr | WorryFreeWiFiMgr |
XmlMgr | XmlMgr |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Custom
Enter the name of a custom CSP that will be declared as Unprotected when the value Unprotect is selected for Use CSP Action.
Use when the CSP to be declared as Unprotected is not in the list of standard CSP names, such as when the CSP is a Plug-In CSP. Standard CSP names COULD be entered, but it would generally be preferable to use Unprotect CSP Name instead, since picking a name from a list is less error-prone than typing the name.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionUnprotectCspNameCustom
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Approve Caller Package
Enter the Android Package Name of an application that should be Approved to use a CSP when the value Approve is selected for Use CSP Action, to identify the specific application that should be Approved to use the CSP.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionApproveCallerPackage
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Approve Caller Signature
Enter the Android Package Signature of an application that should be Approved to use a CSP when the value Approve is selected for Use CSP Action, to provide the Android Package Signature of the specific application that should be Approved to use the CSP.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionApproveCallerSignature
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Approve CSP Name
Select a standard CSP that will be Approved for an application when the value Approve is selected for Use CSP Action.
All standard CSP names are listed and can be picked from the list instead of having to enter them manually. This can help to avoid errors that could occur from mis-typing a CSP name. Custom could alternately be used in cases where typing in the CSP name is preferable.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionApproveCspName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
AccessMgr | AccessMgr |
AnalyticsMgr | AnalyticsMgr |
AppGalleryMgr | AppGalleryMgr |
AppMgr | AppMgr |
AudioMgr | AudioMgr |
AudioVolUIMgr | AudioVolUIMgr |
AutoTriggerMgr | AutoTriggerMgr |
Batch | Batch |
BatteryMgr | BatteryMgr |
BluetoothMgr | BluetoothMgr |
BrowserMgr | BrowserMgr |
BugReportMgr | BugReportMgr |
CameraMgr | CameraMgr |
CellularMgr | CellularMgr |
CertMgr | CertMgr |
Clock | Clock |
ComponentMgr | ComponentMgr |
ConditionMgr | ConditionMgr |
DevAdmin | DevAdmin |
DeviceCentralMgr | DeviceCentralMgr |
DisplayMgr | DisplayMgr |
EncryptMgr | EncryptMgr |
EnterpriseKeyboard | EnterpriseKeyboard |
EthernetMgr | EthernetMgr |
FileMgr | FileMgr |
GmsMgr | GmsMgr |
GooglePlayMgr | GooglePlayMgr |
GprsMgr | GprsMgr |
HostsMgr | HostsMgr |
Intent | Intent |
KeyMappingMgr | KeyMappingMgr |
LicenseMgr | LicenseMgr |
LifeGuardOTAManager | LifeGuardOTAManager |
NfcMgr | NfcMgr |
PersistMgr | PersistMgr |
PersonalDictionary | PersonalDictionary |
PowerKeyMgr | PowerKeyMgr |
PowerMgr | PowerMgr |
RemoteScannerMgr | RemoteScannerMgr |
RfidMgr | RfidMgr |
ScanModeMgr | ScanModeMgr |
SdCardMgr | SdCardMgr |
SettingsMgr | SettingsMgr |
Stats | Stats |
StatusMgr | StatusMgr |
ThreatMgr | ThreatMgr |
TouchMgr | TouchMgr |
UiMgr | UiMgr |
UsbMgr | UsbMgr |
Wi-Fi | Wi-Fi |
WirelessMgr | WirelessMgr |
WorryFreeWiFiMgr | WorryFreeWiFiMgr |
XmlMgr | XmlMgr |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Custom
Enter the name of a custom CSP that will be Approved to use a CSP when the value Approve is selected for Use CSP Action.
Use when the CSP to be Approved for an application is not in the list of standard CSP names, such as when the CSP is a Plug-In CSP. Standard CSP names COULD be entered, but it would generally be preferable to use Approve CSP Name instead, since picking a name from a list is less error-prone than typing the name.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionApproveCspNameCustom
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Unapprove Caller Package
Enter the Android Package Name of an application that should be Unapproved from using a CSP when the value Unapprove is selected for Use CSP Action, to identify the specific application that should be Unapproved from using the CSP.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionUnapproveCallerPackage
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Unapprove Caller Signature
Enter the Android Package Signature of an application that should be Unapproved from using a CSP when the value Unapprove is selected for Use CSP Action, to provide the Android Package Signature of the specific application that should be Unapproved from using the CSP.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionUnapproveCallerSignature
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Unapprove CSP Name
Select a standard CSP that will be Unapproved for an application when the value Unapprove is selected for Use CSP Action.
All standard CSP names are listed and can be picked from the list instead of having to enter them manually. This can help to avoid errors that could occur from mis-typing a CSP name. Custom could alternately be used in cases where typing in the CSP name is preferable.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionUnapproveCspName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
AccessMgr | AccessMgr |
AnalyticsMgr | AnalyticsMgr |
AppGalleryMgr | AppGalleryMgr |
AppMgr | AppMgr |
AudioMgr | AudioMgr |
AudioVolUIMgr | AudioVolUIMgr |
AutoTriggerMgr | AutoTriggerMgr |
Batch | Batch |
BatteryMgr | BatteryMgr |
BluetoothMgr | BluetoothMgr |
BrowserMgr | BrowserMgr |
BugReportMgr | BugReportMgr |
CameraMgr | CameraMgr |
CellularMgr | CellularMgr |
CertMgr | CertMgr |
Clock | Clock |
ComponentMgr | ComponentMgr |
ConditionMgr | ConditionMgr |
DevAdmin | DevAdmin |
DeviceCentralMgr | DeviceCentralMgr |
DisplayMgr | DisplayMgr |
EncryptMgr | EncryptMgr |
EnterpriseKeyboard | EnterpriseKeyboard |
EthernetMgr | EthernetMgr |
FileMgr | FileMgr |
GmsMgr | GmsMgr |
GooglePlayMgr | GooglePlayMgr |
GprsMgr | GprsMgr |
HostsMgr | HostsMgr |
Intent | Intent |
KeyMappingMgr | KeyMappingMgr |
LicenseMgr | LicenseMgr |
LifeGuardOTAManager | LifeGuardOTAManager |
NfcMgr | NfcMgr |
PersistMgr | PersistMgr |
PersonalDictionary | PersonalDictionary |
PowerKeyMgr | PowerKeyMgr |
PowerMgr | PowerMgr |
RemoteScannerMgr | RemoteScannerMgr |
RfidMgr | RfidMgr |
ScanModeMgr | ScanModeMgr |
SdCardMgr | SdCardMgr |
SettingsMgr | SettingsMgr |
Stats | Stats |
StatusMgr | StatusMgr |
ThreatMgr | ThreatMgr |
TouchMgr | TouchMgr |
UiMgr | UiMgr |
UsbMgr | UsbMgr |
Wi-Fi | Wi-Fi |
WirelessMgr | WirelessMgr |
WorryFreeWiFiMgr | WorryFreeWiFiMgr |
XmlMgr | XmlMgr |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Custom
Enter the name of a custom CSP that will be Unapproved for an application when the value Unapprove is selected for Use CSP Action.
Use when the CSP to be Unapproved for an application is not in the list of standard CSP names, such as when the CSP is a Plug-In CSP. Standard CSP names COULD be entered, but it would generally be preferable to use Unapprove CSP Name instead, since picking a name from a list is less error-prone than typing the name.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspActionUnapproveCspNameCustom
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Use CSP Function Group Action
Select an Action to perform for a CSP Function Group.
If the value Create is selected, then a new Custom CSP Function Group will be Created. You must specify Create Group Name to provide the name of the Custom Group to be Created and Create Group Details to define the CSP Functions to be controlled by the Custom Group.
If the value Delete is selected, then an existing, previously Created Custom CSP Function Group will be Deleted. You must specify Delete Group Name to provide the name of the Custom Group to be Deleted.
If the value Protect is selected, then an existing CSP Function Group will be made Protected. You must specify Protect Group Name or Custom to provide the name of the Standard or Custom Group to be made Protected.
If the value Unprotect is selected, then an existing CSP Function Group will be made Unprotected. You must specify Unprotect Group Name or Custom to provide the name of the Standard or Custom Group to be made Unprotected.
If the value Approve is selected, then an Application will be Approved to use all the Functions of an existing CSP Function Group. You must specify Approve Group Name or Custom to provide the name of the Standard or Custom Group and you must specify Approve Caller Package and Approve Caller Signature to identify the Application to be Approved to use the Functions in that Group.
If the value Unapprove is selected, then an Application will be Unapproved from using all the Functions of an existing CSP Function Group. You must specify Unapprove Group Name or Custom to provide the name of the Standard or Custom Group and you must specify Unapprove Caller Package and Unapprove Caller Signature to identify the Application to be Unapproved from using the Functions in that Group.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Create | 1 |
Delete | 2 |
Protect | 3 |
Unprotect | 4 |
Approve | 6 |
Unapprove | 7 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Create Group Details
Enter the Custom Group Details for the Custom CSP Function Group to be Created when Create is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Custom Group Details define which CSP Functions are included in a Custom Group and hence can be Protected together as a set. Custom Group Details are entered as a comma separated list that can include one or more of the following:
- CSPname
Indicates that ALL CSP Function(s) supported by the named CSP are in the Group.
- CSPname:parmname
Indicates that the CSP Function(s) invoked by the named parm within the named CSP are in the Group.
- CSPname:parmname={values}
Indicates that CSP Function(s) invoked by value(s)of the named parm in the named CSP are in the Group.
Multiple values, if specified, must be separated by semi-colon.
Some examples:
- AppMgr,AccessMgr
Group contains ALL CSP Functions in the AppMgr CSP and the AccessMgr CSP.
- AppMgr:Action={Install;Uninstall}
Group contains the 2 CSP Functions in the AppMgr CSP identified by the values Install and Uninstall.
For more information on Zebra MX, see https://techdocs.zebra.com/mx/overview/.
For more information on Zebra MX Custom Group Details, see https://techdocs.zebra.com/mx/accessmgr/.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionCreateGroupDetails
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Create Group Name
Enter the name of the Custom CSP Function Group to be Created when Create is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionCreateGroupName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Delete Group Name
Enter the name of the Custom CSP Function Group to be Deleted when Delete is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionDeleteGroupName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Protect Auto Approve
Select whether Zebra OemConfig should be automatically Approved to use the CSP Functions in this Sub-group when Protect is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionProtectAutoApprove
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Approve | 1 |
Do Not Approve | 0 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Protect Group Name
Select the name of the Standard CSP Function Group to be Protected when Protect is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionProtectGroupName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
CSP Access Management | 1 |
Stop Application | 2 |
Custom Group | 98 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Custom
Enter the name of the Custom CSP Function Group to be Protected when Protect is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionProtectGroupNameCustom
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Unprotect Auto Unapprove
Select whether Zebra OemConfig should be automatically Unapproved from using the CSP Functions in this Sub-group when Unprotect is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionUnprotectAutoUnapprove
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Unapprove | 1 |
Do Not Unapprove | 0 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Unprotect Group Name
Select the name of the Standard CSP Function Group to be Unprotected when Unprotect is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionUnprotectGroupName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
CSP Access Management | 1 |
Stop Application | 2 |
Custom Group | 98 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Custom
Enter the name of the Custom CSP Function Group to be Unprotected when Unprotect is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionUnprotectGroupNameCustom
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Approve Caller Package
Enter the Android Package Name of an Application that should be Approved to use a specified CSP Function Group when Approve is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionApproveCallerPackage
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Approve Caller Signature
Enter the Android Package Signature of an Application that should be Approved to use a specified CSP Function Group when Approve is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionApproveCallerSignature
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Approve Group Name
Select the name of the Standard CSP Function Group to be Approved when Approve is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionApproveGroupName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
CSP Access Management | 1 |
Stop Application | 2 |
Custom Group | 98 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Custom
Enter the name of the Custom CSP Function Group to be Approved when Approve is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionApproveGroupNameCustom
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Unapprove Caller Package
Enter the Android Package Name of an Application that should be Unapproved to use a specified CSP Function Group when Unapprove is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionUnapproveCallerPackage
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Unapprove Caller Signature
Enter the Android Package Signature of an Application that should be Unapproved to use a specified CSP Function Group when Unapprove is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionUnapproveCallerSignature
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Unapprove Group Name
Select the name of the Standard CSP Function Group to be Unapproved when Unapprove is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionUnapproveGroupName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
CSP Access Management | 1 |
Stop Application | 2 |
Custom Group | 98 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Custom
Enter the name of the Custom CSP Function Group to be Unapproved when Unapprove is selected for Use CSP Function Group Action.
Detail Information:
Key = serviceCspFunctionGroupActionUnapproveGroupNameCustom
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.0.
Settings UI Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Allow device user Access Quick Settings, Allow device user Control Airplane Mode, Allow device user Control App Notifications, Allow device user Control Apps, Allow device user Control Background Data, Allow device user Control Ethernet, Allow device user Control Instant Lock, Allow device user Control Unknown Sources, Allow device user Control USB, Allow device user Control WLAN, Allow device user to Initiate an Enterprise Reset, Configure Default Client Mode, Control Access to Device Storage From PC, device user Editing of Quick Tiles, Quick Tiles Action, Quick Tiles Custom Identifier, Quick Tiles Identifier, Settings Panel Access, Show Quick Settings Icon, Use of Notification Settings Icon, Use of Settings Slide Out Drawer, and Use of Tethering and Portable Hotspot.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Allow device user Access Quick Settings
Select whether the device user will be allowed to access the Android Quick Settings Panel UI.
If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the device user to enter the Quick Settings Panel will be ignored.
If the value On is selected, attempts by the device user to enter the Quick Settings Panel will be honored and the Quick Settings Panel UI will be presented on request.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserAccessToQuickSettings
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.2.
Allow device user Control Airplane Mode
Select whether the device user will be allowed to change the state of Airplane Mode.
- If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the device user to change the state of Airplane Mode will be blocked.
- If the value On is selected, attempts by the device user to change the state of Airplane Mode will be honored.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserControlOfAirplaneMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Allow device user Control App Notifications
Select whether the device user will be allowed to configure which application notifications will be generated.
- If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the device user to change the configuration of application notifications will be blocked.
- If the value On is selected, attempts by the device user to change the configuration of application notifications will be honored.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserControlAppNotifications
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.2.
Allow device user Control Apps
Select whether the device user will be allowed to enter the AppInfo section of the Settings UI where applications can be controlled.
- If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the device user to enter the AppInfo section of the Settings UI will be ignored.
- If the value On is selected, attempts by the device user to enter the AppInfo section of the Settings will be honored.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserControlApps
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Allow device user Control Background Data
Select whether the device user will be allowed to change the usage of Background WWAN data.
- If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the device user to change the usage of Background WWAN data will be blocked.
- If the value On is selected, attempts by the device user to change the usage of Background WWAN data will be honored.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserControlOfBackgroundData
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Allow device user Control Ethernet
Select whether the device user will be allowed to change the state of the Ethernet adapter.
- If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the device user to change the state of Ethernet adapter will be blocked.
- If the value On is selected, attempts by the device user to change the state of Ethernet adapter will be honored.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserControlOfEthernet
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Allow device user Control Instant Lock
Select whether the device user will be allowed to change whether pressing the Power key causes the device to lock instantly.
- If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the device user to change whether pressing the Power key causes the device to lock instantly will be blocked.
- If the value On is selected, attempts by the device user to change whether pressing the Power key causes the device to lock instantly will be honored.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserControlInstantLock
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Allow device user Control Unknown Sources
Select whether the device user will be allowed to change whether applications can be installed from Unknown Sources.
- If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the device user to change whether applications can be installed from Unknown Sources.
- If the value On is selected, attempts by the device user to change whether applications can be installed from Unknown Sources.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserControlUnknownSources
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Nougat.
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Support discontinued from: MX 9.0.
Allow device user Control USB
Select whether the device user will be allowed to change the state of USB.
- If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the device user to change the state of USB will be blocked.
- If the value On is selected, attempts by the device user to change the state of USB will be honored.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserControlOfUsb
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
Allow device user Control WLAN
Select whether the device user will be allowed to change the configuration of the WLAN adapter.
- If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the device user to change the configuration of the WLAN adapter will be blocked.
- If the value On is selected, attempts by the device user to change the configuration of the WLAN adapter will be honored.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserControlWlan
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Allow device user to Initiate an Enterprise Reset
Select whether the device user will be allowed to perform an Enterprise Reset from the Settings UI.
- If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the device user to perform an Enterprise Reset from the Settings UI will be blocked.
- If the value On is selected, attempts by the device user to perform an Enterprise Reset from the Settings UI will be honored.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserInitiateEnterpriseReset
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.2.
Configure Default Client Mode
Select the default configuration of an attached USB client.
If the value Charging Only (no data transfer) is selected, "Charging Only" will be the default mode for client USB devices.
If the value File Transfer is selected, "File Transfer" will be the default mode for client USB devices.
If the value MIDI is selected, "MIDI" will be the default mode for client USB devices.
If the value PTP is selected, "PTP" will be the default mode for client USB devices.
If the value USB Tethering is selected, "USB Tethering" will be the default mode for client USB devices.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUsbClientModeDefault
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Charging Only (no data transfer) | 0 |
File Transfer | 4 |
MIDI | 8 |
PTP | 16 |
USB Tethering | 32 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 10.4.
Control Access to Device Storage From PC
Select whether the device user will be allowed to change the state of USB.
- If the value Disable is selected, PC access is blocked and any attempt by the device user to change the state of PC access will be blocked.
- If the value Enable is selected, PC access is allowed and attempts by the device user to change the state of PC access will be honored.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUserControlOfDeviceStorageFromPC
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disable | 2 |
Enable | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.2.
device user Editing of Quick Tiles
Select whether the device user is allowed to Edit which Quick Tiles will be shown in Quick Settings.
If the value Disallow is selected, the device user will NOT be allowed to initiate Editing of which Quick Tiles will be shown in Quick Settings.
If the value Allow is selected, the device user will be allowed to initiate Editing of which Quick Tiles will be shown in Quick Settings.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsDeviceUserEditQuickTiles
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.2.
Quick Tiles Action
Select the action to show/hide Quick Settings tiles on the device.
If the value Reset to Default is selected, the Quick Tiles shown in Quick Settings will reset to default.
If the value Hide individual is selected, an individual Quick Tile will be hidden in Quick Settings.
If the value Show individual is selected, an individual Quick Tile will be shown in Quick Settings.
If the value Hide all is selected, all Quick Tiles will be hidden in Quick Settings.
If the value Show all is selected, all Quick Tiles will be shown in Quick Settings.
Detail Information:
Key = settingQuickTilesAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Show all | 1 |
Hide all | 2 |
Show individual | 3 |
Hide individual | 4 |
Reset to Default | 5 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.2.
Quick Tiles Custom Identifier
Enter the name of the custom Quick Setting tile to show/hide on the device
Detail Information:
Key = settingQuickTilesCustomIdentifier
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.2.
Quick Tiles Identifier
Select the action to show/hide a specific Quick Settings tile on the device.
If the value Airplane mode is selected, the Airplane mode Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Auto-rotate is selected, the Auto-rotate Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Battery Saver is selected, the Battery Saver Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Bedtime mode is selected, the Bedtime mode Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Bluetooth is selected, the Bluetooth Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Dark theme is selected, the Dark Theme Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Data Saver is selected, the Data Saver Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Do Not Disturb is selected, the Do Not Disturb Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Dump SysUI Heap is selected, the Dump SysUI Heap Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Flashlight is selected, the Flashlight Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Focus mode is selected, the Focus mode Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Hotspot is selected, the Hotspot Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Invert colors is selected, the Invert colors Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Location is selected, the Location Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Mobile data is selected, the Mobile data Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value NFC is selected, the NFC Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Nearby Share is selected, the Nearby Share Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Night Light is selected, the Night Light Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Screen Cast is selected, the Screen Cast Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Screen Record is selected, the Screen Record Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Wi-Fi is selected, the Wi-Fi Quick Settings Tile will be shown or hidden
If the value Custom is selected, a name of the custom Quick Settings Tile must be entered to be shown or hidden
Detail Information:
Key = settingQuickTilesIdentifier
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Airplane mode | Airplane mode |
Auto-rotate | Auto-rotate |
Battery Saver | Battery Saver |
Bedtime mode | Bedtime mode |
Bluetooth | Bluetooth |
Dark theme | Dark theme |
Data Saver | Data Saver |
Do Not Disturb | Do Not Disturb |
Dump SysUI Heap | Dump SysUI Heap |
Flashlight | Flashlight |
Focus mode | Focus mode |
Hotspot | Hotspot |
Invert colors | Invert colors |
Location | Location |
Mobile data | Mobile data |
NFC | NFC |
Nearby Share | Nearby Share |
Night Light | Night Light |
Screen Cast | Screen Cast |
Screen Record | Screen Record |
Wi-Fi | Wi-Fi |
Custom | Custom |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.2.
Settings Panel Access
Select the access to the Settings Panel (UI) that will be provided to the device user.
If the value Full is selected, Full access to all settings will be provided when the device user launches the Settings Panel (UI).
If the value Partial is selected, Partial access to reduced subset of settings will be provided when the device user launches the Settings Panel (UI).
If the value None (Supported from MX 11.2) is selected, the device user will not be allowed to launch the Settings Panel (UI). Supported from MX 11.2.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUseReducedVersion
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Full | 1 |
Partial | 2 |
None (Supported from MX 11.2) | 3 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.1.
Show Quick Settings Icon
Select whether the device user will be allowed to invoke the Settings UI using an icon on the Quick Settings Panel.
- If the value Off is selected, any attempt by the use of the icon to invoke the Settings UI will be blocked.
- If the value On is selected, the use of the icon to invoke the Settings UI will be allowed.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsShowQuickSettingsIcon
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.1.
Use of Notification Settings Icon
Select whether the device user is allowed to use the Settings Icon on the Notification Panel to launch the Settings UI.
- If the value Off is selected, the device user will be blocked from using the Settings Icon on the Notification Panel to launch the Settings UI.
- If the value On is selected, the device user will be allowed to use the Settings Icon on the Notification Panel to launch the Settings UI.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUseOfNotificationSettingsIcon
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 5.1.
Use of Settings Slide Out Drawer
Select whether the device user is allowed to use the Slide Out Drawer in Settings UI to rapidly switch laterally to other parts of the Settings UI.
- If the value Off is selected, the device user will be blocked from using the Slide Out Drawer in Settings UI to rapidly switch laterally to other parts of the Settings UI.
- If the value On is selected, the device user will be allowed to use the Slide Out Drawer in Settings UI to rapidly switch laterally to other parts of the Settings UI
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUseOfSlideOutDrawer
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Support discontinued from: MX 9.0.
Use of Tethering and Portable Hotspot
Select whether the device user is allowed to use the Settings Icon on the Notification Panel to launch the Settings UI.
- If the value Disallow is selected, the device user will be blocked from using the Settings UI to configure and utilize Tethering and Portable Hotspot mode.
- If the value Allow is selected, the device user will be allowed to use the Settings UI to configure and utilize Tethering and Portable Hotspot mode.
Detail Information:
Key = settingsUseOfTetheringAndPortableHotspot
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Threat Management Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Action, Detect Threat Type, Detect Countermeasures, Action Detect Threat Type MDM Client Removal Package Name, Ignore Threat Type, Periodic Scan, Interval, Additional Folders, List, and Send Externally Detected Threat Message.
Detail Information:
Key = threatStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Action
Select an Action to configure whether a given threat will be monitored.
- If the value Detect is selected, a specific threat will be configured to be monitored and, if that threat is detected, a countermeasure will be taken to mitigate that threat. You must also specify Detect Threat Type to provide the threat that will be monitored. In addition, you must also specify the Sub-array Detect Countermeasures to provide the set of countermeasures that will be performed if the specified threat is detected.
- If the value Ignore is selected, a specific threat will be configured to not be monitored and hence will never be detected. You must also specify Ignore Threat Type to provide the threat that will be ignored.
Detail Information:
Key = threatAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Detect | Detect |
Ignore | Ignore |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Detect Threat Type
Select the type of threat that will be monitored when the value Detect is selected forAction.
- If the value Max Password Attempts is selected, the Threat Management System will be configured to monitor password entry attempts and the threat will be considered to be detected if the maximum number of unsuccessful password entry attempts are made without an intervening successful password entry.
- If the value MDM Client Removal is selected, the Threat Management System will be configured to monitor the device and detect if a specific Android Package Name is ever uninstalled from the device. You must also specify Action Detect Threat Type MDM Client Removal Package Name to provide the Android Package Name that will be monitored. While this is typically used to detect the removal of the MDM Client, which would render a managed device unmanaged, it could be used to detect the removal of ANY application, if detection of the removal of an MDM Agent is not required.
- If the value Externally Detected is selected, the Threat Management System will be configured to listen for indication from an application on the device that can itself provide a way of detecting an signaling any threat not otherwise known to the Threat Management System. The Threat Management System will consider the threat to have been detected whenever it is signaled by the external application.
- If the value Exchange Active Sync Command is selected, the Threat Management System will be configured to handle a threat detected and signaled by a connection to an Exchange Active Sync Server via an Exchange Active Sync Client on the device.
- If the value Device is Rooted is selected, the Threat Management System will be configured to monitor the device to see if it has been rooted. Root detection mechanism seek to identify common exploits that could grant an escalated privileges to an untrusted application that might use them to compromise the security or privacy of the device.
Detail Information:
Key = threatActionDetectThreatType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Max Password Attempts | MaxPasswordAttempts |
MDM Client Removal | MDMClientRemoval |
Externally Detected | ExternallyDetected |
Exchange Active Sync Command | ExchangeActiveSyncCommand |
Device is Rooted | DeviceisRooted |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Detect Countermeasures
Use this Sub-array to configure one or more Countermeasure(s).
Detail Information:
Key = threatActionDetectCountermeasures
Type = bundle_array
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Countermeasure
Use this Sub-group to configure Type, Uninstall Package Name, Unsolicited Alert Package Name, Unsolicited Alert Class, and Unsolicited Alert Message.
Detail Information:
Key = threatCountermeasure
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Type
Select the type of a single countermeasure that will be performed to mitigate a detected threat.
- If the value FormatSdcard is selected, the countermeasure to format the removable SD Card will be performed when the associated threat is detected.
- If the value FactoryReset is selected, the countermeasure to Factory Reset the device will be performed when the associated threat is detected.
- If the value WipeSecureStorageKeys is selected, the countermeasure to Wipe all encryption keys, deployed via the Group Security Configuration will be performed when the associated threat is detected.
- If the value LockDevice is selected, the countermeasure to lock the device, requiring it to be unlocked by the device user, will be performed when the associated threat is detected.
- If the value UninstallApplication is selected, the countermeasure to Uninstall an application will be performed when the associated threat is detected. You must also specify Uninstall Package Name to provide the Android Package Name of the application that will be uninstalled.
- If the value UnsolicitedAlert is selected, the countermeasure to send an unsolicited alert via an Android Intent will be performed when the associated threat is detected. You must also specify Unsolicited Alert Package Name, Unsolicited Alert Class, and Unsolicited Alert Message to provide the information needed to deliver the alert.
Detail Information:
Key = threatCountermeasureType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
FormatSdcard | FormatSdcard |
FactoryReset | FactoryReset |
WipeSecureStorageKeys | WipeSecureStorageKeys |
LockDevice | LockDevice |
UninstallApplication | UninstallApplication |
UnsolicitedAlert | UnsolicitedAlert |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Uninstall Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name of an application that will be uninstalled as a countermeasure to mitigate a threat when the value UninstallApplication is selected for Type.
Detail Information:
Key = threatCountermeasureUninstallPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Unsolicited Alert Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name of an application that will be sent an unsolicited alert to notify it that a threat has been detected as a countermeasure to mitigate a threat when the value UnsolicitedAlert is selected for Type.
Detail Information:
Key = threatCountermeasureUnsolicitedAlertPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Unsolicited Alert Class
Enter the Class Name of component within an application that will be sent an unsolicited alert to notify it that a threat has been detected as a countermeasure to mitigate a threat when the value UnsolicitedAlert is selected for Type.
Detail Information:
Key = threatCountermeasureUnsolicitedAlertClass
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Unsolicited Alert Message
Enter the string text message that will be sent to a component of an application via an unsolicited alert to notify it that a threat has been detected as a countermeasure to mitigate a threat when the value UnsolicitedAlert is selected for Type.
Detail Information:
Key = threatCountermeasureUnsolicitedAlertMessage
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Action Detect Threat Type MDM Client Removal Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name of the MDM Agent that will be monitored to detect a threat when the value MDM Client Removal is selected for Detect Threat Type.
Detail Information:
Key = threatMdmClientPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Ignore Threat Type
Select the type of threat that will NOT be monitored, and hence cannot be detected, when the value Ignore is selected forAction.
- If the value Max Password Attempts is selected, the Threat Management System will be configured to NOT monitor password entry attempts and hence will never detect the threat of exceeding the maximum number of unsuccessful password entry attempts.
- If the value MDM Client Removal is selected, the Threat Management System will be configured to NOT monitor the device and detect if a specific Android Package Name is ever uninstalled from the device, and hence will never detect the threat of removal of the MDM Client.
- If the value Externally Detected is selected, the Threat Management System will be configured to NOT listen for indication from an application on the device that can signal a threat and hence no external threats will ever be detected.
- If the value Exchange Active Sync Command is selected, the Threat Management System will be configured NOT to handle a threat detected and signaled by a connection to an Exchange Active Sync Server via an Exchange Active Sync Client on the device and hence such threats will never be detected.
- If the value Device is Rooted is selected, the Threat Management System will be configured to NOT monitor the device to see if it has been rooted and hence the threat of the device being rooted will never be detected.
Detail Information:
Key = threatActionIgnoreThreatType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Max Password Attempts | MaxPasswordAttempts |
MDM Client Removal | MDMClientRemoval |
Externally Detected | ExternallyDetected |
Exchange Active Sync Command | ExchangeActiveSyncCommand |
Device is Rooted | DeviceisRooted |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Periodic Scan
Select whether the Threat Management System should perform background polling to increase the accuracy and timeliness of detection of Rooted Device threat.
- If the value Off is selected, the Threat Management System will NOT perform background polling. This may increase performance and improve battery life somewhat, but will reduce the ability to detect the Rooted Device threat and or result in a delay in detection of that threat.
- If the value On is selected, the Threat Management System will perform background polling. This may reduce performance and degrade battery life somewhat, but will increase the ability to detect the Rooted Device threat and accelerate detection of that threat. You may also specify Interval, Additional Folders, and List to adjust the nature of the background polling, allowing trade-offs to be made in the balance pf thoroughness vs. the impact to performance and battery life. This value should generally be selected when detection of the Device is Rooted threat has been enabled, since it would have little value otherwise.
Detail Information:
Key = threatPeriodicScan
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.1.
Interval
Enter the interval between polls when the value On is selected for Periodic Scan.
The interval is specified in seconds between polls.
- Choosing a lower value can increase the aggressiveness of detection of rooted devices, which can reduce the time required to successfully detect that a device has been rooted, but can also reduce the impact of polling on performance and battery life. - Choose a higher value can reduce the aggressiveness of detection of rooted devices, which can increase the time required to successfully detect that a device has been rooted, but can also decrease the impact of polling on performance and battery life.
Detail Information:
Key = threatPeriodicScanInterval
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.1.
Additional Folders
Select whether additional folders will be polled when the value On is selected for Periodic Scan.
When background polling to detect device rooting is performed, the Threat Management System will always scan certain key folders that are considered common or likely locations where changes might occur that could signal that device has been rooted. In some cases, rooting might occur through changes made to other folders.
- If the value Off is selected, the Threat Management System will only scan the default folders.
- If the value On is selected, the Threat Management System will scan the default folders plus additional folders. You must also specify List to identify the list of additional folders to be scanned.
Detail Information:
Key = threatPeriodicScanAdditionalFolders
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.1.
List
Enter list of additional folders that will be polled when the value On is selected for Periodic Scan and the value On is selected for Additional Folders.
Detail Information:
Key = threatPeriodicScanAdditionalFoldersList
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.1.
Send Externally Detected Threat Message
Enter the message which will signal the detection of an externally detected threat. This would generally be relevant only if the Externally Detected was selected for Detect Threat Type, since any signaling of an externally detected threat would otherwise be ignored.
Detail Information:
Key = threatSendExternallyDetectedMessage
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Volume UI Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Action, Add Profile Name, Add Profile Streams, Remove Profile Name, Set Current Profile Name, and Set Current Profile Adjust Volume.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Action
Select an Action to alter the UI behavior of the Zebra Volume Control on a device.
The Zebra Volume Control provides a configurable UI that allows the device users to adjust the volume of one or more Audio Streams on a device. The UI behavior of the Zebra Volume Control is configured by defining one or more Audio UI Profiles and controlling which Audio UI Profile is active. Each Audio UI Profile defines which Audio Streams can be configured and adjusts the experience of the device user when adjusting the volumes of those Audio Streams. The Zebra Volume Control also has a Factory Preset Audio UI Profile that can be used to return the behavior of the Zebra Volume Control to it default out-of-box state.
- If the value Add Profile is selected, a new Audio UI Profile is added to the list of Audio UI Profiles. You must also specify Add Profile Name and Add Profile Streams to define the Audio UI Profile being added.
- If the value Remove Profile is selected, an existing Audio UI Profile is removed from the list of Audio UI Profiles. You must also specify Remove Profile Name to provide the name that identifies the Audio UI Profile to be removed.
- If the value Set Current Profile is selected, an existing Audio UI Profile is set to be the active Audio UI Profile. You must also specify Set Current Profile Name to provide the name that identifies the Audio UI Profile to be made the new active Audio UI Profile.
- If the value Apply Current Profile is selected, the currently active Audio UI Profile is applied to the current device Volume Settings. If the current device Volume Settings are outside the range of Volume Settings defined for the currently active Audio UI Profile the current device Volume Settings will be adjusted as needed to bring them within the range of Volume Settings defined for the currently active Audio UI Profile.
- If the value Set Factory Preset is selected, the Factory Preset Audio UI Profile is made the active Audio UI Profile, causing the behavior of the Zebra Volume Control to return to its default out-of-box state.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Add Profile | 1 |
Remove Profile | 2 |
Set Current Profile | 01 |
Apply Current Profile | 02 |
Set Factory Preset | 03 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Add Profile Name
Enter the name of a new Audio UI Profile to be added when the value Add Profile is selected for Action.
- If an Audio UI Profile with the specified name already exists, the new Audio UI Profile will replace the existing Audio UI Profile with that name.
- If no Audio UI Profile with the specified name already exists, the new Audio UI Profile will be added with that name.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiActionAddProfileName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Add Profile Streams
Use this Sub-array to configure one or more Stream(s) to configure when the value Add Profile is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiActionAddProfileStreams
Type = bundle_array
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Stream
Use this Sub-group to configure Type, Label, Icon, Visible, and Modes configured as part of a new Audio UI Profile being added when the value Add Profile is selected for Action within the Sub-array Stream.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiStream
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Type
Select the type of a single Audio Stream that will be included as part of a new Audio UI Profile being added within each instance of the Sub-group Stream within Sub-array Add Profile Streams. You must also specify Label, Icon, Visible, and Modes to define the characteristics of the new Audio Stream of the specified type that will be added.
- If the value Music is selected, the Audio Stream to be added to the new Audio UI Profile will define the behavior of the Zebra Volume Control with respect to the Audio Stream used for playback of Music and other Media.
- If the value Ring is selected, the Audio Stream to be added to the new Audio UI Profile will define the behavior of the Zebra Volume Control with respect to the Audio Stream used for ringtones.
- If the value Notification is selected, the Audio Stream to be added to the new Audio UI Profile will define the behavior of the Zebra Volume Control with respect to the Audio Stream used for notifications.
- If the value System is selected, the Audio Stream to be added to the new Audio UI Profile will define the behavior of the Zebra Volume Control with respect to the Audio Stream used for system sounds.
- If the value Alarm is selected, the Audio Stream to be added to the new Audio UI Profile will define the behavior of the Zebra Volume Control with respect to the Audio Stream used for alarms.
- If the value VoiceCall is selected, the Audio Stream to be added to the new Audio UI Profile will define the behavior of the Zebra Volume Control with respect to the Audio Stream used for voice calls.
- If the value VVS is selected, the Audio Stream to be added to the new Audio UI Profile will define the behavior of the Zebra Volume Control with respect to the Audio Stream used for Decode Beep Vertical Volume Scale (VVS).
- If the value KeypadTone is selected, the Audio Stream to be added to the new Audio UI Profile will define the behavior of the Zebra Volume Control with respect to the Audio Stream used for the keypad tone.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiStreamType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Music | Music |
Ring | Ring |
Notification | Notification |
System | System |
Alarm | Alarm |
VoiceCall | VoiceCall |
VVS | VVS |
KeypadTone | KeypadTone |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Label
Enter the text label to be displayed for a single Audio Stream that will be included as part of a new Audio UI Profile being added and may be specified within each instance of the group Stream within the Sub-array Add Profile Streams.
The text label might be changed for an Audio Stream because it is used for some purpose(s) other than the one identified by the default text label. Changing the text label to something more description of the actual purpose(s) for which the Audio Stream is used can make the Zebra Volume Control behavior more intuitive for the device user.
If no text label is selected for an Audio Stream, the Factory Preset default text label will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiStreamLabel
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Icon
Enter the icon to be displayed for a single Audio Stream that will be included as part of a new Audio UI Profile being added and may be specified within each instance of the group Stream within the Sub-array Add Profile Streams.
The icon might be changed for an Audio Stream because it is used for some purpose(s) other than the one identified by the default text label. Changing the icon to something more representative of the actual purpose(s) for which the Audio Stream is used can make the Zebra Volume Control behavior more intuitive for the device user.
If an icon is specified, the value specified must be the full path and file name of a PNG format icon file that must already be present in the device file system. An icon size of 48x48 pixels is recommended.
If no icon is selected for an Audio Stream, the Factory Preset default icon will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiStreamIcon
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Visible
Enter a value indicating whether the single Audio Stream will be visible to the device user within the Zebra Volume Control when it is included as part of a new Audio UI Profile being added and may be specified within each instance of the Group Stream within the Sub-array Add Profile Streams.
If the value 0 is entered, then the Audio Stream will NOT be visible to the device user.
If the value 1 is entered, then the Audio Stream WILL be visible to the device user.
If no value (an empty string) is entered, then the visibility of the Audio Stream will not be changed.
If an Audio Stream is made not visible for an Audio UI Profile, the Zebra Volume Control will not present ANY UI to the device user to control the volume of that Audio Stream. The result is basically identical to not including the Audio Stream in the Audio UI Profile. This might be used when temporarily disabling an Audio Stream to avoid the need to remove and then add back in the entire definition of that Audio Stream.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiStreamVisible
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Modes
Use this Sub-array to configure one or more Mode(s) to specify the behaviors of the UI for a single Audio Stream in one or more modes as part of a new Audio UI Profile being added when the value Add Profile is selected for Action and as part of an instance of the group Stream within the Sub-array Add Profile Streams.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiStreamModes
Type = bundle_array
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Mode
Use this Sub-group to configure Minimum, Maximum, Preset, and Type to define the behavior of the UI for a single Audio Stream in a single Audio Mode as part of a new Audio UI Profile being added when the value Add Profile is selected for Action within the Sub-array Modes as an instance of the Group Stream within the Sub-array Add Profile Streams.
For each Audio Mode defined for an Audio Stream, You must also specify Type to provide which Audio Mode will be defined. You must also specify Minimum, Maximum, and Preset to define the lower, upper, and default (preset) volume levels for that Audio Mode within that Audio Stream.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiMode
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Minimum
Enter the minimum volume level that the UI will allow the device user to select for a single Audio Stream in a single Audio Mode as part of a new Audio UI Profile being added when the value Add Profile is selected for Action within the Sub-array Modes as an instance of the Group Stream within the Sub-array Add Profile Streams.
The value must be an integer that is greater than 0 and less than 256, with 1 being the lowest possible volume level and 255 being the highest possible volume level.
You must also specify Maximum and Preset to define the complete behavior of a single Audio Mode within a single Audio Stream.
The value specified must be less than or equal to the value entered for Maximum and less than or equal to the value entered for Preset.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiModeMin
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Maximum
Enter the maximum volume level that the UI will allow the device user to select for a single Audio Stream in a single Audio Mode as part of a new Audio UI Profile being added when the value Add Profile is selected for Action within the Sub-array Modes as an instance of the Group Stream within the Sub-array Add Profile Streams.
The value must be an integer that is greater than 0 and less than 256, with 1 being the lowest possible volume level and 255 being the highest possible volume level.
You must also specify Minimum and Preset to define the complete behavior of a single Audio Mode within a single Audio Stream.
The value specified must be greater than or equal to the value entered for Minimum and greater than or equal to the value entered for Preset.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiModeMax
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Preset
Enter the preset volume level that the UI will allow the device user to select for a single Audio Stream in a single Audio Mode as part of a new Audio UI Profile being added when the value Add Profile is selected for Action within the Sub-array Modes as an instance of the Group Stream within the Sub-array Add Profile Streams.
The value must be an integer that is greater than 0 and less than 256, with 1 being the lowest possible volume level and 255 being the highest possible volume level.
You must also specify Minimum and Maximum to define the complete behavior of a single Audio Mode within a single Audio Stream.
The value specified must be greater than or equal to the value entered for Minimum and less than or equal to the value entered for Maximum.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiModePreset
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Type
Select the type of behavior of the UI for a single Audio Stream in a single Audio Mode as part of a new Audio UI Profile being added when the value Add Profile is selected for Action within the Sub-array Modes as an instance of the Group Stream within the Sub-array Add Profile Streams.
- If the value Speaker is selected, the Audio Mode will be configured for the Audio Stream under conditions where the Audio Stream is being routed to the built-in device speaker.
- If the value Receiver is selected, the Audio Mode will be configured for the Audio Stream under conditions where the Audio Stream is being routed to receiver mode.
- If the value WiredHeadset is selected, the Audio Mode will be configured for the Audio Stream under conditions where the Audio Stream is being routed to a wired audio headset.
- If the value BluetoothHeadset is selected, the Audio Mode will be configured for the Audio Stream under conditions where the Audio Stream is being routed to a wireless Bluetooth audio headset.
- if the value TBD is selected, the "Audio Mode" will be configured for the "Audio Stream" under conditions where the "Audio Stream" is being routed to the HDMI output. NOTE: Only applies the "Music" type.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiModeType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Speaker | Speaker |
Receiver | Receiver |
WiredHeadset | WiredHeadset |
BluetoothHeadset | BluetoothHeadset |
Hdmi | Hdmi |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Remove Profile Name
Enter the name of an existing Audio UI Profile to be removed when the value Remove Profile is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiActionRemoveProfileName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Set Current Profile Name
Enter the name of an existing Audio UI Profile to be made the current active Audio UI Profile when the value Set Current Profile is selected for Action. You must also specify Set Current Profile Adjust Volume to control whether the current device Volume Settings will be adjusted to ensure that they fall within the range of Volume Settings defined by the Audio UI Profile.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiActionSetCurrentProfileName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Set Current Profile Adjust Volume
Select whether the current device Volume Settings will be adjusted to ensure that they fall within the range of Volume Settings defined by an Audio UI Profile being made the new current Audio UI Profile to be made the current active Audio UI Profilewhen the value Set Current Profile is selected for Action and Set Current Profile Name is specified.
Detail Information:
Key = volumeuiActionSetCurrentProfileAdjustVolume
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | Off |
On | On |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Wakeup Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Wakeup Sources.
Detail Information:
Key = wakeupStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Wakeup Sources
Select whether all controllable Wakeup Sources should be turned on or off.
If the value Off is selected, all wakeup sources that can be turned on or off will be turned off, causing the physical events corresponding to those wakeup sources to be ignored and hence NOT to cause the device to wakeup from a suspend state.
If the value On is selected, all wakeup sources that can be turned on or off will be turned on, causing the physical events corresponding to those wakeup sources to be honored and hence to cause the device to wakeup from a suspend state.
Detail Information:
Key = wakeupSources
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.0.
Whitelist Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Mode, Action, Allow Package Name, Allow Signature, Disallow Signature, Disallow Package Name, and State
Whitelisting applies only to user applications; it has no effect on System applications, which are applications built into the device and are therefore always present. User applications are those that DO NOT come preinstalled on the device, but are installed during staging or at some time after the device is put into service. System apps are controlled using the Blacklist Configuration Group.
WARNING: It is important to understand that if an app uses the Whitelist Configuration Group to enable whitelisting, then that app becomes subject to whitelisting. If the app does not add itself to the "whitelist," the app is prevented from running once the configuration is successfully applied. .
Detail Information:
Key = whitelistStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.1.
Mode
Select the Whitelisting Mode, which determines how the applications that can be installed and run on a device will be controlled.
- If the value Package Name Only is selected, when configuring which applications can be installed and run, only the Android Package Name will be used to identify the allowed applications.
- If the value Package Name and Signature is selected, when configuring which applications can be installed and run, both the Android Package Name and the Package Signature will be used to identify the allowed applications.
Using the value Package Name and Signature provides significantly better security than using Package Name Only since it provides much stronger protection against spoofing. If Package Name Only is used, any APK whose Android Package Name matches one of the allowed Android Package Names will be allowed to be installed and run. Since any APK can be assigned any Android Package Name, the potential for a rogue application circumventing the protections of Whitelisting is relatively high. If Package Name and Signature is used, the Android Package Signature of an application must match an allowed Android Package Signature in addition to the Android Package Name matching an allowed Android Package Name. Since a rogue APK cannot be signed with a given Android Package Signature without possessing the corresponding Private Key, the chances of successfully spoofing are greatly reduced, and effectively eliminated if Private Keys are properly controlled.
Detail Information:
Key = whitelistMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Package Name Only | 1 |
Package Name and Signature | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Action
Select an Action to alter the Whitelisting configuration of a device.
- If the value Allow is selected, a single application will be allowed to be installed and run. You must also specify Allow Package Name to provide the Android Package Name of the application that will be allowed. In addition, if the value Package Name and Signature is selected for Mode, you must also specify Allow Signature to provide the Android Package Signature to be allowed.
- If the value Disallow is selected, a single application will be prevented from being installed and run. You must also specify Disallow Package Name to provide the Android Package Name of the application that will be disallowed.
Detail Information:
Key = whitelistAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Allow | Add |
Disallow | Delete |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Allow Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name of an application to be allowed when the value Allow is selected for Action.
- If the value Package Name and Signature is selected for Mode, you must also specify Allow Signature to provide the Android Package Signature to be allowed.
Detail Information:
Key = whitelistActionAddPackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.1.
Allow Signature
Enter the Android Package Signature of an application to be allowed when the value Allow is selected for Action, Allow Package Name is specified, and the value Package Name and Signature is selected for Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = whitelistActionAddSignature
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Disallow Signature
Enter the Android Package Signature of an application to be disallowed when the value Disallow is selected for Action, and when Disallow Package Name is specified, and when the value Package Name and Signature is selected for Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = whitelistActionDeleteSignature
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Disallow Package Name
Enter the Android Package Name of an application to be disallowed when the value Disallow is selected for Action.
If the value Package Name and Signature is selected for Mode, you must also specify Disallow Signature to provide the Android Package Signature to be allowed.
Detail Information:
Key = whitelistActionDeletePackageName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.1.
State
Select the Whitelisting State, which determines whether the set of applications that can be installed and run on a device will be controlled.
If the value Off is selected, Whitelisting will not be used and no restrictions will be placed on which applications can be installed and run.
If the value On is selected, Whitelisting will be used and you should specify additional configuration in the Group to configure how the set of applications will be controlled and which applications will be allowed to be installed and run.
Detail Information:
Key = whitelistState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 1 |
On | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.1.
Wireless General Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Antenna Selection, Bluetooth Scanning State, GPS Location Mode, GPS Power State, Location State, and Wi-Fi Scanning State.
Detail Information:
Key = wirelessStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Antenna Selection
Select which of multiple antennas should be used for wireless communications.
If the value Internal is selected, the internal built-in antenna will be used.
If the value External is selected, an externally connected antenna will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = wirelessAntennaSelection
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Internal | 1 |
External | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 7.1.
Bluetooth Scanning State
Select whether Bluetooth scanning is to be used to improve location
- If the value Turn On is selected, system apps and services will detect Bluetooth devices and use them to improve location
- If the value Turn Off is selected, system apps and services will not detect Bluetooth devices and will not use them to improve location
Detail Information:
Key = wirelessGpsBluetoothScanning
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Turn On | 1 |
Turn Off | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.4.
GPS Location Mode
Select whether the GPS radio state should be On or Off.
- If the value Device Only is selected, the GPS location mode is set to Device Only. Location is determined using only the GPS radio, which is subject to signal loss in some settings.
- If the value Battery Saving is selected, the GPS location mode is set to Battery Saving. Location is determined using using only Wi-Fi and cellular information, preserving battery life.
- If the value High Accuracy is selected, the GPS location mode is set to High Accuracy. Location is determined using GPS, Wi-Fi and cellular network information to determine device location with the highest degree of accuracy.
Detail Information:
Key = wirelessGpsLocationMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
High Accuracy | 1 |
Battery Saving | 2 |
Device Only | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.1.
GPS Power State
Select to configure whether the GPS radio state should be On or Off.
- If the value Off is selected, the GPS radio state will be turned off, preventing GPS-based location detection from being performed.
- If the value On is selected, the GPS radio state will be turned on, allowing GPS-based location detection to be performed, given satellite availability.
Detail Information:
Key = wirelessGpsPowerState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.3.
Location State
Select whether to use location services.
- If the value Turn On is selected, location services will be active.
- If the value Turn Off is selected, location services will not be active.
Detail Information:
Key = wirelessLocationState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Turn On | 1 |
Turn Off | 2 |
Support Information:
- NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Wi-Fi Scanning State
Select whether Wi-Fi scanning is to be used to improve location
- If the value Turn On is selected, system apps and services will detect Wi-Fi networks and use them to improve location
- If the value Turn Off is selected, system apps and services will not detect Wi-Fi networks and will not use them to improve location
Detail Information:
Key = wirelessGpsWifiScanning
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Turn On | 1 |
Turn Off | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.4.
Wireless LAN Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Auto Wakeup, Bands, Channels, Country, Hotspot State, Hotspot Options, Network Notification, Verbose Logging, Omnitrail, Advanced Options, Diagnostics Options, and Fine Timing Measurement (FTM) - Changes made using this Sub-group will generally affect the operation of ALL WLAN Networks.
- This Sub-group does NOT allow management of specific WLAN Profiles. To manage WLAN Profiles, consult the documentation for your specific EMM. .
Detail Information:
Key = wlanStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.4.
Auto Wakeup
Select whether Wi-Fi (not the device) should Wake Up (turn on) automatically when the presence of a previously connected network is detected.
If the value Off is selected, automatic Wake Up will be turned OFF, preventing the device from detecting the presence of a previously connected network and automatically waking up to connect to it.
If the value On is selected, automatic Wake Up will be turned ON, allowing the device to periodically scan for and detect the presence of a previously connected network and automatically wake up to connect to it.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanAutoWakeup
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Bands
Select the frequency Bands on which the WLAN subsystem will operate on a device:
- If the value 2.4GHz is selected, only the 2.4 Gigahertz (Ghz) Band (used by 802.11b and 802.11g) will be used.
- If the value 5.0GHz is selected, only the 5.0 Gigahertz (Ghz) Band (used by 802.11a) will be used.
- If the value Auto is selected, the Band to be used will be determined automatically.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanBands
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
2.4GHz | 2.4GHz |
5.0GHz | 5.0GHz |
Auto | Auto |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.1.
Channels
Enter the channels over which the WLAN subsystem will operate on a device.
The format of the value entered must be 64 characters or less and can specify one or more channels by separating values by commas and/or specifying ranges of values by separating the lower and upper range values with a dash (-). Some examples: - 1,2,3 - 3,6,7-9,11-13
The actual channel that can specified depends on the value selected for Bands.
- If the value 2.4GHz is selected for Bands, channels must be selected that are in the 2.4 Ghz band.
- If the value 5.0GHz is selected for Bands, channels must be selected that are in the 5.0 Ghz band.
- If the value Auto is selected Bands, channels may be selected that are in either band.
Note that individual countries may apply their own regulations regarding the channels that are allowable. Therefore, depending on the value selected for Country, not all channel values that could be specified for a given band may be allowable.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanChannels
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.1.
Country
Select the Country in which the WLAN subsystem will operate on a device:
- If the value Auto (Use 802.11d) is selected, the Country to be used will be determined automatically.
- When any other value is selected, the specified Country will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanCountry
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Auto (Use 802.11d) | AUTO |
Algeria | DZ |
Anguilla | AI |
Argentina | AR |
Australia | AU |
Austria | AT |
Bahamas | BS |
Bahrain | BH |
Barbados | BB |
Belarus | BY |
Belgium | BE |
Bermuda | BM |
Bolivia | BO |
Bonaire | BQ |
Bosnia and Herzegovina | BA |
Brazil | BR |
Bulgaria | BG |
Canada | CA |
Cayman Islands | KY |
Chile | CL |
China | CN |
Christmas Island | CX |
Columbia | CO |
Costa Rica | CR |
Croatia | HR |
Curacao | CW |
Cyprus | CY |
Czech Republic | CA |
Denmark | DK |
Dominican Republic | DO |
Ecuador | EC |
Egypt | EG |
El Salvador | SV |
Estonia | EE |
Falkland Islands(Malvinas) | FK |
Finland | FI |
France | FR |
French Guiana | GF |
Germany | DE |
Greece | GR |
Guadelope | GP |
Guam | GU |
Guatemala | GT |
Guyana | GY |
Haiti | HT |
Honduras | HN |
HongKong | HK |
Hungary | HU |
Iceland | IS |
India | IN |
Indonesia | ID |
Ireland | IE |
Israel | IL |
Italy | IT |
Jamaica | JM |
Japan | JP |
Jordan | JO |
Kazakhstan | KZ |
Kenya | KE |
Korea Republic | KR |
Kuwait | KW |
Latvia | LV |
Lebanon | LB |
Liechtenstein | LI |
Lithuania | LT |
Luxembourg | LU |
Macedonia | MK |
Malaysia | MY |
Malta | MT |
Martinique | MQ |
Mexico | MX |
Montenegro | ME |
Morocco | MA |
Netherlands | AN |
Netherlands | NL |
NewZeaLand | NZ |
Nicaragua | NI |
Nigeria | NG |
Niue | NU |
Norfolk Islands | NF |
Northern Marina Islands | MP |
Norway | NO |
Oman | OM |
Pakistan | PK |
Panama | PA |
Paraguay | PY |
Peru | PE |
Philippines | PH |
Poland | PL |
Portugal | PT |
Puerto Rico | PR |
Qatar | QA |
Romania | RO |
Russian Federation | RU |
St. Maarten | SX |
Saudi Arabia | SA |
Serbia | RS |
Singapore | SG |
Slovakia | SK |
Slovenia | SI |
South Africa | ZA |
Spain | ES |
Sri Lanka | LK |
Sweden | SE |
Switzerland | CH |
Taiwan | TW |
Thailand | TH |
Trinidad and Tobago | TT |
Tunisia | TN |
Turkey | TR |
Ukraine | UA |
United Arab Emirates | AE |
United Kingdom | GB |
U.S.A. | US |
Uruguay | UY |
Venezuela | VE |
Vietnam | VN |
Virgin Islands(British) | VG |
Virgin Islands(US) | VI |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.1.
Hotspot State
Select the state of the Hotspot Mode of the WLAN adapter on a device.
If the value Off is selected, the Hotspot Mode will be turned OFF, preventing the device from sharing its Internet connection as a WLAN Hotspot. Any other existing configuration related to Hotspot Mode will not be affected, allowing Hotspot Mode to be configured and tested, turned OFF and back ON without having to reconfigure it.
If the value On is selected, the Hotspot Mode will be turned ON, allowing the device to share its Internet connection as a WLAN Hotspot, subject to appropriate configuration related to Hotspot Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanHotSpotState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Hotspot Options
Use this Sub-group to configure SSID, Band, Band 2.4GHz Channel, 5GHz Channel, Security Mode, and Security Passphrase
All the settings is this Sub-group can be configured independently of the state of Hotspot Mode, thus allowing Hotspot Mode to be configured before it is turned ON and allowing the configuration of Hotspot Mode to be established and maintained across multiple changes to the state of Hotspot Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanHotSpotOptions
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
SSID
Enter the Service Set Identifier (SSID) that will identify the network supported in Hotspot Mode of the WLAN adapter on a device.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanHotSpotSSID
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Band
Select the Frequency Band in which Hotspot Mode of the WLAN adapter will operate on a device.
- If the value 2.4GHz is selected, the Hotspot Mode of the WLAN adapter will operate solely in the 2.4 Gigahertz (GHz) Frequency Band and hence only devices capable of operating in that Frequency Band will be capable of sharing the Internet connection of the device via Hotspot Mode.
- If the value 5GHz is selected, the Hotspot Mode of the WLAN adapter will operate solely in the 5.0 Gigahertz (GHz) Frequency Band and hence only devices capable of operating in that Frequency Band will be capable of sharing the Internet connection of the device via Hotspot Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanHotSpotBand
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
2.4GHz | 0 |
5GHz | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Band 2.4GHz Channel
Select the single 2.4 HGHz Channel in which Hotspot Mode of the WLAN adapter will operate on a device and should be specified when the value 2.4GHz is selected for Band.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanHotSpot24GHzChannel
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
1 | 1 |
2 | 2 |
3 | 3 |
4 | 4 |
5 | 5 |
6 | 6 |
7 | 7 |
8 | 8 |
9 | 9 |
10 | 10 |
11 | 11 |
12 | 12 |
13 | 13 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
5GHz Channel
Select the single 5.0 HGHz Channel in which Hotspot Mode of the WLAN adapter will operate on a device when the value 5GHz is selected for Band.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanHotSpotBand5GhzChannel
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
36 | 36 |
40 | 40 |
44 | 44 |
48 | 48 |
52 | 52 |
56 | 56 |
60 | 60 |
64 | 64 |
100 | 100 |
104 | 104 |
108 | 108 |
112 | 112 |
116 | 116 |
120 | 120 |
124 | 124 |
128 | 128 |
132 | 132 |
136 | 136 |
140 | 140 |
149 | 149 |
153 | 153 |
157 | 157 |
161 | 161 |
165 | 165 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Security Mode
Select the Security Mode to be used to secure the Hotspot Mode of the WLAN adapter will operate on a device.
- If the value Open is selected, the WLAN adapter will apply no security for Hotspot Mode, thus providing no control over which devices can connect and share the Internet connection of the device via Hotspot Mode.
- If the value WPA2/PSK is selected, the WLAN adapter will apply Wi-Fi Protected Access Version 2 (WPA2) Pre-shared Key (PSK) security for Hotspot Mode, thus providing some control over which devices can connect and share the Internet connection of the device via Hotspot Mode. You must also specify Security Passphrase to provide the PSK passphrase that will be used to secure the network.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanHotSpotSecurityMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Open | 0 |
WPA2/PSK | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Security Passphrase
Enter the PSK passphrase that will be used to secure the Hotspot Mode network implemented by the WLAN adapter on a device, when the value WPA2/PSK is selected for Security Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanHotSpotSecurityPassphrase
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Network Notification
Select whether the device user will be notified about, and allowed to connect to, new WLANs that are detected.
If the value Off is selected, the device user will NOT be notified about, nor allowed to connect to, new WLANs that are detected.
If the value On is selected, the device user will be notified about, and allowed to connect to, new WLANs that are detected.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanNetworkNotification
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.1.
Verbose Logging
Select whether the Verbose Logging feature of the WLAN adapter should be turned ON or OFF on a device.
If the value Off is selected, the Verbose Logging will be turned OFF, preventing the device from logging additional information for debugging or troubleshooting WLAN issues.
If the value On is selected, the Verbose Logging will be turned ON, allowing the device to log additional information for debugging or troubleshooting WLAN issues.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanVerboseLogging
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Omnitrail
Use this Sub-group to configure State, Interval, Standard, Options, and Datarate.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanOmnitrail
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
State
Select whether the Omnitrail feature of the WLAN adapter is turned On or Off for a device.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanOmnitrailState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Interval
Enter the interval at which the Omnitrail feature of the WLAN adapter should emit a locational beacon on a device.
The value provided should be in milliseconds (ms) and should have a value in the range of 200 ms (0.2 seconds) to 5000 ms (5 seconds).
Detail Information:
Key = wlanOmnitrailInterval
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Standard
Select an omnittrail datarate standard to be used by the WLAN adapter on a device. You must also specify Datarate to provide the actual datarate to be used.
- If the value abg is selected, the Omnitrail datarate standard will be set for 802.11a, 802.11b, and 802,11g.
- If the value 11n is selected, the Omnitrail datarate standard will be set for 802.11n.
- If the value 11ac is selected, the Omnitrail datarate standard will be set for 802.11a and 802,11c.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanOmnitrailDatarateStandard
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
abg | 0 |
11n | 1 |
11ac | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Options
Use this Sub-array to configure one or more Option Pair(s).
Detail Information:
Key = wlanOmnitrailOptions
Type = bundle_array
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Option Pair
Use this Sub-group to configure Name, Name Custom, and Value.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanOmnitrailOptionPair
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Name
Select a standard name that identifies a single Omnitrail optOmnitrail option to be configured for the WLAN adapter on a device. You must also specify Value to provide the value to be set for the Omnitrail option identified by the selected name.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanOmnitrailOptionName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
OmniTrailChannel | OmniTrailChannel |
OmniTrailSubtype | OmniTrailSubtype |
OmniTrailPriority | OmniTrailPriority |
OmniTrailFlag | OmniTrailFlag |
OmniTrailType | OmniTrailType |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Name Custom
Enter a custom name that identifies a Omnitrail option to be configured for the WLAN adapter on a device. You must also specify Value to provide the value to be set for the Omnitrail option identified by the specified name.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanOmnitrailOptionCustomName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Value
Enter a value for a single Omnitrail option to be configured for the WLAN adapter on a device when Name or Name Custom are also specified to provide the name needed identity the Omnitrail option to be set.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanOmnitrailOptionValue
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Datarate
Select an omnittrail datarate to be used by the WLAN adapter on a device when Standard is also specified to identify the datarate standard.
- If the value abg is selected for Standard, the following datarates can be selected.
- 1
- 2
- 5.5
- 6
- 9
- 11
- 12
- 18
- 24
- 36
- 48
- 54
- If the value 11n is selected for Standard, the following datarates can be selected.
- MCS0
- MCS1
- MCS2
- MCS3
- MCS4
- MCS5
- MCS6
- MCS7
- MCS8
- MCS9
- MCS10
- MCS11
- MCS12
- MCS13
- MCS14
- MCS15
- If the value 11ac is selected for Standard, the following datarates can be selected.
- MCS0_1
- MCS1_1
- MCS2_1
- MCS3_1
- MCS4_1
- MCS5_1
- MCS6_1
- MCS7_1
- MCS8_1
- MCS9_1
- MCS0_2
- MCS1_2
- MCS2_2
- MCS3_2
- MCS4_2
- MCS5_2
- MCS6_2
- MCS7_2
- MCS8_2
- MCS9_2
Detail Information:
Key = wlanOmnitrailDatarate
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
1 | 0 |
2 | 1 |
5.5 | 2 |
6 | 3 |
9 | 4 |
11 | 5 |
12 | 6 |
18 | 7 |
24 | 8 |
36 | 9 |
48 | 10 |
54 | 11 |
MCS0 | 12 |
MCS1 | 13 |
MCS2 | 14 |
MCS3 | 15 |
MCS4 | 16 |
MCS5 | 17 |
MCS6 | 18 |
MCS7 | 19 |
MCS8 | 20 |
MCS9 | 21 |
MCS10 | 22 |
MCS11 | 23 |
MCS12 | 24 |
MCS13 | 25 |
MCS14 | 26 |
MCS15 | 27 |
MCS0_1 | 28 |
MCS1_1 | 29 |
MCS2_1 | 30 |
MCS3_1 | 31 |
MCS4_1 | 32 |
MCS5_1 | 33 |
MCS6_1 | 34 |
MCS7_1 | 35 |
MCS8_1 | 36 |
MCS9_1 | 37 |
MCS0_2 | 38 |
MCS1_2 | 39 |
MCS2_2 | 40 |
MCS3_2 | 41 |
MCS4_2 | 42 |
MCS5_2 | 43 |
MCS6_2 | 44 |
MCS7_2 | 45 |
MCS8_2 | 46 |
MCS9_2 | 47 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.0.
Advanced Options
Use this Sub-array to configure one or more Option Pair(s).
Detail Information:
Key = wlanAdvancedOptions
Type = bundle_array
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.4.
Option Pair
Use this Sub-group to configure Name, Custom Name, and Value.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanAdvancedOptionPair
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.4.
Name
Select a standard name that identifies a single advanced option to be configured for the WLAN adapter on a device. You must also specify Value to provide the value to be set for the advanced option identified by the selected name.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanAdvancedOptionName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
AutoTimeConfig | AutoTimeConfig |
HFSR | HFSR |
CCKM | CCKM |
FT | FT |
FTRIC | FTRIC |
OKC | OKC |
PMKID | PMKID |
PreAuth | PreAuth |
PowerSave | PowerSave |
WLANPowerSave | WLANPowerSave |
AdvancedLogging | AdvancedLogging |
FIPS | FIPS |
EnableRestrictedSettingsUI | EnableRestrictedSettingsUI |
802.11K | 802.11K |
802.11w | 802.11w |
802.11ac | 802.11ac |
802.11n | 802.11n |
802.11v | 802.11v |
BandPreference | BandPreference |
FTOverTheDS | FTOverTheDS |
AggregatedFT | AggregatedFT |
ScanAssist | ScanAssist |
CHD | CHD |
SubNetRoam | SubNetRoam |
WANCountry | WANCountry |
PasswordProtectEncryption | PasswordProtectEncryption |
MACRandomization | MACRandomization |
CallAdmissionControl | CallAdmissionControl |
EnableAmpdu | EnableAmpdu |
GratuitousARP | GratuitousARP |
ChannelBondingMode2g | ChannelBondingMode2g |
WLANExtendedConfig | WLANExtendedConfig |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.4.
Custom Name
Enter a custom name that identifies a single advanced option to be configured for the WLAN adapter on a device. You must also specify Value to provide the value to be set for the advanced option identified by the specified name.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanAdvancedOptionCustomName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.4.
Value
Enter a value for a single advanced option to be configured for the WLAN adapter on a device and should be specified when Name or Custom Name are specified to provide the name of the advanced option.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanAdvancedOptionValue
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.4.
Diagnostics Options
Use this Sub-array to configure one or more Option Pair(s).
Detail Information:
Key = wlanDiagnosticsOptions
Type = bundle_array
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Option Pair
Use this Sub-group to configure Name, Name Custom, and Value.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanDiagnosticsOptionPair
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Name
Select a standard name that identifies a single Diagnostic Option to be configured for the WLAN adapter on a device. You must also specify Value to provide the value to be set for the Diagnostic Option identified by the specified name.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanDiagnosticsOptionName
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
FusionAdvancedLogging | FusionAdvancedLogging |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Name Custom
Enter a custom name that identifies a single Diagnostic Option to be configured for the WLAN adapter on a device. You must also specify Value to provide the value to be set for the Diagnostic Option identified by the specified name.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanDiagnosticsOptionCustomName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Value
Enter a value for a single Diagnostic Option to be configured for the WLAN adapter on a device. You must also specify Name or Name Custom to provide the name that identifies the Diagnostic Option to be set.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanDiagnosticsOptionValue
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
Fine Timing Measurement (FTM) Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure AP Deployment File, AP Source, and Deployment Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanFTM
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
AP Deployment File
Enter the AP Target path and file name which contains the AP coordinates used Fine Timing Measurement (FTM) used by the WLAN adapter.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanFTMAPFile
Type = string
Support Information:
- NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
AP Source
Select the AP Source for Fine Timing Measurement (FTM) used by the WLAN adapter.
- if Location XML is selected, then AP Deployment File must also be entered.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanFTMAPSource
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Location XML | 0 |
Location from LCR/LCI | 1 |
Support Information:
- NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Deployment Mode
Select the deployment mode for Fine Timing Measurement (FTM) used by the WLAN adapter.
Detail Information:
Key = wlanFTMDeploymentMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Standard (FTM enabled) | 0 |
Enhanced Infra (FTM-enabled) | 1 |
Support Information:
- NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Wireless WAN Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure Power, Background Data, Select eSIM Memory Reset Slot ID, Select eSIM Profile for Memory Reset, SIM Card Slot, Data Limit State, Custom Limit, Data Warning Threshold, Control of Service Type, User Control of Background Data, User Control of Data Limit, User Control of Power, User Control of Sim Socket, Public Land Mobile Network Lock, Value, User Control of Public Land Mobile Network Lock, Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode, DSDS Features, Device Administrator Advanced Features, Mobile Network Operator Advanced Features, and Service Technician Advanced Features.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanStep
Type = bundle
Power
Select the Power State of the WWAN Adapter.
A given device may or may not support a WWAN Adapter. An attempt to configure the WWAN Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanPower
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.3.
Background Data
Select whether WWAN data can be used by applications that are in the Background.
- If the value Disallow is selected, the use of WWAN data by applications that are in the Background will be prevented.
- If the value Allow is selected, the use of WWAN data by applications that are in the Background will be allowed.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanBackgroundData
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 4.3.
Select eSIM Memory Reset Slot ID
Select the Slot ID to perform an eSIM memory erase.
- If the value 2 is selected, then slot id number two is selected.
- If the value 1 is selected, then slot id number one is selected.
Detail Information:
Key = ESimMemoryResetSlotId
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
2 | 2 |
1 | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.0.
Select eSIM Profile for Memory Reset
Select the profile type to perform an eSIM memory erase.
- If the value EraseSMDPPLUSAddress is selected, then SMDP PLUS profile is erased
- If the value EraseOperationalProfiles is selected, then operational profiles are erased
- If the value EraseTestProfiles is selected, then test profiles are erased
- If the value EraseAll is selected, then all profiles are erased
Detail Information:
Key = ESimMemoryResetTypeAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
EraseAll | 1 |
EraseTestProfiles | 2 |
EraseOperationalProfiles | 3 |
EraseSMDPPLUSAddress | 4 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 11.0.
SIM Card Slot
Select the SIM Card slot that will be used by the WWAN adapter.
A given device may or may not support a WWAN Adapter. An attempt to configure the WWAN Adapter on a device that does not have one will result in an error. A given device may have a limited number of SIM Card slots. An attempt to configure the WWAN Adapter to use an unsupported SIM Card slot will result in an error. A given device may support a given SIM car slot, but that SIM car slot may not contain a SIM Card. An attempt to configure the WWAN Adapter to use a supported but unpopulated SIM Card slot will result in an error.
If the value Slot 1 is selected, the WWAN adapter will attempt to use the SIM Card slot designated as Slot 1.
If the value Slot 2 is selected, the WWAN adapter will attempt to use the SIM Card slot designated as Slot 2.
If the value Slot 3 is selected, the WWAN adapter will attempt to use the SIM Card slot designated as Slot 3.
If the value Slot 4 is selected, the WWAN adapter will attempt to use the SIM Card slot designated as Slot 4.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanSimCardSlot
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Slot 1 | 1 |
Slot 2 | 2 |
Slot 3 | 3 |
Slot 4 | 4 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.2.
Data Limit State
Select whether a limit should be imposed on the amount of WWAN data used, such as to cap telecom expenses.
- If the value Enable and set default limit is selected, a default limit will be imposed on the amount of WWAN data that can be used.
- If the value Enable and set custom limit is selected, a custom limit will be imposed on the amount of WWAN data that can be used and you must also specify Custom Limit to provide the desired custom limit.
- If the value Disable is selected, no limit will be imposed on the amount of WWAN data that can be used.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDataLimitState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Enable and set default limit | 1 |
Enable and set custom limit | 2 |
Disable | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Custom Limit
Enter a custom limit that should be imposed on the amount of WWAN data used, such as to cap telecom expenses, when the value Enable and set custom limit is selected for Data Limit State.
The custom limit should be an integer value specifying the maximum amount of WWAN data that can be used, in megabytes (MB).
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDataLimitStateCustomLimit
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
Data Warning Threshold
Enter a threshold such that if the amount of WWAN data that has been used exceeds that threshold then a warning will be generated to the device user.
The threshold should be an integer value specifying the threshold amount of WWAN data, in megabytes (MB).
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDataWarningThreshold
Type = integer
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 6.3.
Control of Service Type
Select the service type
- If the value Data Only is selected, the service type of Data Only will be used.
- If the value Voice + Data is selected, the service type of Voice + Data will be used.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanServiceType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Data Only | 2 |
Voice + Data | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 10.0.
User Control of Background Data
Select whether a device user is allowed to use the in-device Settings Menu to change whether applications running in the background are allowed to communicate using the WWAN adapter.
If the value Disallow is selected, the device user will be blocked from using the Settings UI to change whether applications running in the background are allowed to communicate using the WWAN adapter. You can use this to ensure that configurations you have made related to usage of background data cannot be overridden by the device user.
If the value Allow is selected, the device user will be allowed to use the Settings UI to change whether applications running in the background are allowed to communicate using the WWAN adapter. This can be used to allow the device user to override configurations related to usage of background data that you have made.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanUserControlBackgroundData
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 4.4.
User Control of Data Limit
Select whether a device user is allowed to use the in-device Settings Menu to change limits on how much data can be communicated using the WWAN adapter.
If the value Disallow is selected, the device user will be blocked from using the Settings UI to change limits on how much data can be communicated using the WWAN adapter. This can be used to ensure that configurations you have made related to to data limits cannot be overridden by the device user.
If the value Allow is selected, the device user will be allowed to use the Settings UI to change limits on how much data can be communicated using the WWAN adapter. This can be used to allow the device user to override configurations related to data limits that you have made.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanUserControlDataLimit
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
User Control of Power
Select whether a device user is allowed to use the in-device Settings Menu to change the Power State of the WWAN adapter.
- If the value Disallow is selected, the device user will be blocked from using the Settings UI to change the Power State of the WWAN adapter. This can be used to ensure that the configurations related to the Power State of the WWAN adapter cannot be overridden by the device user.
- If the value Allow is selected, the device user will be allowed to use the Settings UI to change the Power State of the WWAN adapter. This can be used to allow the device user to override configurations related to the Power State of the WWAN adapter that you have made.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanUserControlPower
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.3.
User Control of Sim Socket
Select whether a device user is allowed to use the in-device Settings Menu to select which SIM slot will be used by the WWAN adapter.
- If the value Disallow is selected, the device user will be blocked from using the Settings UI to select which SIM slot will be used by the WWAN adapter. This can be used to ensure that configurations related to the SIM slot selection cannot be overridden by the device user.
- If the value Allow is selected, the device user will be allowed to use the Settings UI to select which SIM slot will be used by the WWAN adapter. This can be used to allow the device user to override configurations related to the SIM slot selection that you have made. NOTE: control of the user's ability to change the state has been deprecated in Android 10 and will be discontinued in Android 11. This is because the interface that allows the user to make changes has been removed.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanUserControlSimSocket
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 6.2.
Public Land Mobile Network Lock
Select whether the WWAN adapter should be locked to a single Public Land Mobile Network Lock (PLMN).
- If the value Off is selected, the WWAN adapter will NOT be locked to a single Public Land Mobile Network Lock (PLMN) and will be free to connect to any PLMN that is compatible with the SIM Card being used.
- If the value On is selected, the WWAN adapter will be locked to a single Public Land Mobile Network Lock (PLMN) and will only be able to connect to that PLMN. You must also specify Value to provide the value that identifies the PLMN to which the WWAN adapter should be locked.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanPlmnLock
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Value
Enter the value that identifies the Public Land Mobile Network Lock (PLMN) to which the WWAN adapter should be locked when the value On is selected for Public Land Mobile Network Lock. to a single Public Land Mobile Network Lock (PLMN).
The value provided to identify a PLMN must specify both the Mobile Country Code (MCC) and the Mobile Network Code (MNC). Since all MCC values are three digits and MNC values can be 2 or 3 digits, the value provided must be of the format XXXYY or XXXYYY, where XXX is the three digit MCC value and YY or YYY is the 2 or 3 digit MNC value.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanPlmnLockValue
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
User Control of Public Land Mobile Network Lock
Select whether a device user is allowed to control locking of the WWAN adapter to a single Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN).
- If the value Disallow is selected, the device user will be blocked from using the Settings UI to control locking of the WWAN adapter to a single Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN). This can be used to ensure that configurations related to locking of the WWAN adapter to a single Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN) cannot be overridden by the device user.
- If the value Allow is selected, the device user will be allowed to use the Settings UI to control locking of the WWAN adapter to a single Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN). This can be used to allow the device user to override any configurations related to locking of the WWAN adapter to a single Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN) that you have made.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanUserControlPlmnLock
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 2 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode
Select whether the WWAN adapter should handle multiple SIM Card(s) in Dual SIM Dual Standby (DSDS) Mode.
If the value Off is selected, the WWAN adapter will be configured to handle multiple SIM Cards in Single SIM Mode, which means that ONLY the Subscription for the currently selected SIM will be available for use. To use a different Subscription, a different SIM must be explicitly selected by specifying SIM Card Slot.
If the value On is selected, the WWAN adapter will be configured to handle multiple SIM Cards in Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode, which means that two SIM Cards, if present, can be active at the same time. This can be beneficial if the Subscriptions for those SIMs have different performance, pricing, coverage, etc. The default behavior in Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode is for Incoming Voice Calls and Incoming Text Messages to be received using BOTH Subscriptions, Outgoing Voice Calls and Outgoing Text Messages to ask the device user which Subscription to use, and Data Communications to use the Subscription for the primary SIM. You can also use the Sub-group DSDS Features to modify the default behavior of Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode.
NOTE: when configuring this setting on a device running Android 11 or later, the setting takes effect immediately. For devices running Android 10 or earlier a reboot is required for the setting to take effect.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDualSimDualStandby
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 2 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
Supported on Device(s): L10, TC57, and TC77.
Supported from: MX 8.1.
DSDS Features
Use this Sub-group to configure Subscription Selection, Automatic Out of Service Timeout, Automatic Preferred Subscription SIM, Manual Preferred Data Subscription SIM, Manual Preferred Voice Call Subscription SIM, and Manual Preferred Text Message Subscription SIM Use when the value On is selected for Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDualSimDualStandbyFeatures
Type = bundle
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Oreo and Android 10.
Supported on Device(s): L10, TC57, and TC77.
Subscription Selection
Select how Subscription Selection should be performed, when the value On is selected for Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode.
If the value Automatic is selected, Automatic Subscription Selection will be used. You can specify the preferred SIM, and hence the preferred Subscription, to use for Data Communications, Voice Calls, and Text Messages collectively, by specifying Automatic Preferred Subscription SIM. If you do not specify a preferred Subscription, the Subscription for the primary SIM will be used as the preferred Subsciption. The preferred Subscription will be used as the current Subscription when it is in an In Service condition. When the current Subscription is in a sustained Out of Service condition, an automatic switch to the Subscription for the other SIM will be performed if that Subscription is in an In Service condition. You must specify Automatic Out of Service Timeout to provide the duration that the current Subscription must remain in an Out of Service condition before automatic switching to the other Subscription can occur.
If the value Manual is selected, Manual Subscription Selection will be used. You can select the preferred SIM, and hence the preferred Subscription, to use for Data Communications, Voice Calls, and Text Messages independently, by specifying Manual Preferred Data Subscription SIM, Manual Preferred Voice Call Subscription SIM, and Manual Preferred Text Message Subscription SIM, respectively. If you do not specify a preferred Subscription for any service, then the Subscription for the primary SIM will be used as the preferred Subscription.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDualSimSubscriptionSelection
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Manual | 2 |
Automatic | 1 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Oreo and Android 10.
Supported on Device(s): L10, TC57, and TC77.
Supported from: MX 10.0.
Automatic Out of Service Timeout
Enter a duration in seconds that the Subscription for the current SIM must remain in an Out of Service condition before automatic switching to the Subscription for the other SIM may occur, when the value On is selected for Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode and the value Automatic is selected for Subscription Selection.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDualSimSubscriptionSelectionAutomaticOutOfServiceTimeout
Type = integer
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Oreo and Android 10.
Supported on Device(s): L10, TC57, and TC77.
Supported from: MX 10.0.
Automatic Preferred Subscription SIM
Select the SIM that identifies the Subscription to be used as the preferred Subscription, when the value On is selected for Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode and the value Automatic is selected for Subscription Selection.
The Subscription for the selected SIM will be the initial default Subscription to use and the preferred Subscription to use to if the Subscriptions for both SIMs are in an In Service condition.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDualSimSubscriptionSelectionAutomaticPreferredSubscriptionSim
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
SIM 1 | 1 |
SIM 2 | 2 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Oreo and Android 10.
Supported on Device(s): L10, TC57, and TC77.
Supported from: MX 10.0.
Manual Preferred Data Subscription SIM
Select the SIM that identifies the Subscription to be used as the preferred Subscription for Data Communications, when the value On is selected for Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode and the value Manual is selected for Subscription Selection. If you do not specify a preferred Subscription, then the Subscription for the primary SIM will be used as the preferred Subscription.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDualSimSubscriptionSelectionManualPreferredDataSubscriptionSim
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
SIM 1 | 1 |
SIM 2 | 2 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Oreo and Android 10.
Supported on Device(s): L10, TC57, and TC77.
Supported from: MX 10.0.
Manual Preferred Voice Call Subscription SIM
Select the SIM that identifies the Subscription to be used as the preferred Subscription for Voice Calls, when the value On is selected for Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode and the value Manual is selected for Subscription Selection.
If the value Ask is selected, then no preferred Subscription for Voice Calls will be specified and the device user will be asked each time an Outgoing Voice Call is initiated.
If the value SIM 1 or SIM 2 is selected, then the Subscription for the selected SIM will be used as the preferred Subscription for Voice Calls and the device user will NOT be asked each time an Outgoing Voice Call is initiated.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDualSimSubscriptionSelectionManualPreferredVoiceCallSubscriptionSim
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Ask | 1 |
SIM 1 | 2 |
SIM 2 | 3 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Oreo and Android 10.
Supported on Device(s): L10, TC57, and TC77.
Supported from: MX 10.0.
Manual Preferred Text Message Subscription SIM
Select the SIM that identifies the Subscription to be used as the preferred Subscription for Text Messages, when the value On is selected for Dual SIM Dual Standby Mode and the value Manual is selected for Subscription Selection.
If the value Ask is selected, then no preferred Subscription for Text Messages will be specified and the device user will be asked each time an Outgoing Text Message is initiated.
If the value SIM 1 or SIM 2 is selected, then the Subscription for the selected SIM will be used as the preferred Subscription for Text Messages and the device user will NOT be asked each time an Outgoing Text Messages is initiated.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDualSimSubscriptionSelectionManualPreferredTextMessageSubscriptionSim
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Ask | 1 |
SIM 1 | 2 |
SIM 2 | 3 |
Support Information:
Supported on Operating System(s): Oreo and Android 10.
Supported on Device(s): L10, TC57, and TC77.
Supported from: MX 10.0.
Device Administrator Advanced Features
Use this Sub-group to configure Lock Action, Lock Type, Lock Unlock Code, Lock Unlock Retry Count, Lock Network List, Lock ICCID, Unlock Type, and Unlock Unlock Code.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDaAdvancedFeatures
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock Action
Select the Lock Action to be performed.
- If the value Lock is selected, you must also specify Lock Type, Lock Unlock Code, Lock Unlock Retry Count, and Lock Network List to provide the detail information required to perform the Lock. You must also specify Lock ICCID if the value ICCID Lock is selected for Lock Type. If the value Unlock is selected, you must also specify Lock Type to identify the type of prior Lock to be Unlocked and you must also specify Lock Unlock Code to provide the same Unlock Code provided when the Lock was performed.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDaLockAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Lock | 1 |
Unlock | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock Type
Select the Lock Type to be used for a Lock Action to be performed.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDaLockActionLockType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Network Lock | 0 |
ICCID Lock | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock Unlock Code
Enter a string value to use as the Unlock Code for a Lock Action. The same value will need to be provided to perform a subsequent Unlock Action.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDaLockActionLockUnlockCode
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock Unlock Retry Count
Enter the integer Retry Count, from 1-99, for a Lock Action, indicating the maximum number of times a subsequent Unlock Action can be attempted unsuccessfully before disallowing Unlock.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDaLockActionLockUnlockRetryCount
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock Network List
Enter the Network List, as one or more MCC or MNC values, identifying the network(s) to which a device should be Locked. To provide multiple values, separate with commas (e.g. 1,310410,31012).
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDaLockActionLockNetworkList
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock ICCID
Enter the ICCID, also known as the SIM Card identifier, identifying the ICCID/SIM Card to which a device should be Locked.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDaLockActionLockIccid
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Unlock Type
Select the the Unlock Type to be used for a Unlock Action to be performed. This should match the Lock Type of the prior Lock Action to be reversed.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDaLockActionUnlockType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Network Unlock | 0 |
ICCID Unlock | 1 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Unlock Unlock Code
Enter a string value to use as the Unlock Code for an Unlock Action. This must be the same value previously specified for the Lock Action to be reversed.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanDaLockActionUnlockUnlockCode
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Mobile Network Operator Advanced Features
Use this Sub-group to configure Lock Action, Lock Activation ID, Lock Control Key, Lock Unlock Retry Count, Lock Network List, and Unlock Unlock Code.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanMnoAdvancedFeatures
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock Action
Select the Lock Action to be performed.
If the value Lock is selected, you must also specify Lock Activation ID, Lock Control Key, Lock Network List, and Lock Unlock Retry Count to provide the detail information required to perform the Lock.
If the value Unlock is selected, you must also specify Unlock Unlock Code to provide the device-specific Unlock Code provided by the MNO that Locked the device and that is required to reverse the Lock.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanMnoLockAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Lock | 1 |
Unlock | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock Activation ID
Enter the Activation ID that will grant the MNO the permission to perform a Lock Action. The Activation ID must be acquired by an MNO from Zebra and typically will be tied to a set of pre-defined device identities and will enable an MNO to Lock those devices but no others.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanMnoLockActionLockActivationId
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock Control Key
Enter the Control Key that will later be used to create Unlock Codes for devices Locked using that Control Key. An MNO can later use a tool provided by Zebra to produce individual one-time-use Unlock Codes that can be used to Unlock individual devices that were previously Locked by that MNO using that Control Key.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanMnoLockActionLockControlKey
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock Unlock Retry Count
Enter the integer Retry Count, from 1-99, for a Lock Action, indicating the maximum number of times a subsequent Unlock Action can be attempted unsuccessfully before disallowing Unlock.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanMnoLockActionLockUnlockRetryCount
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Lock Network List
Enter the Network List, as one or more MCC or MNC values, identifying the network(s) to which a device should be Locked. To provide multiple values, separate with commas (e.g. 1,310410,31012).
Detail Information:
Key = wwanMnoLockActionLockNetworkList
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Unlock Unlock Code
Enter a string value to use as the Unlock Code for an Unlock Action. This must be a device-specific value provided by the MNO that originally performed the Lock Action to be reversed.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanMnoLockActionUnlockUnlockCode
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Service Technician Advanced Features
Use this Sub-group to configure Activation ID, Export Lock Info, Wipe Lock Info, and Import Lock Info.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanSvcAdvancedFeatures
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Activation ID
Enter the Activation ID that will grant the Service Technician the permission to perform a Service operation. The Activation ID must be acquired by a Service Technician from Zebra.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanSvcActivationId
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Export Lock Info
Select whether the current MNO Lock Information will be Exported and stored to a file on the SD Card of the device.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanSvcExport
Type = boolean
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Wipe Lock Info
Select whether the current MNO Lock Information will be Wiped, thus forcing the device to return to an Unlocked state.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanSvcWipe
Type = boolean
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Import Lock Info
Select whether MNO Lock Information will be Imported from a file stored on the SD Card of the device and used to Lock a device based on information previously Exported from the same or a different device.
Detail Information:
Key = wwanSvcImport
Type = boolean
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 9.2.
Worry Free WiFi Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure State, Global Settings, Analysis Type, Roam/Voice Duration, Voice Packet Filtering Rule, Action, Start Server Analytics, Start Analysis Mode, Start Analysis SSID, Start Session Name, Start Logger Report Level, Start Ping Type, Start Remote Gateway Type, Custom Server Address, Start SD Card Storage, Start Session Storage Duration, Packet Capture, and Coverage View.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
State
Select the state of the Worry Free WiFi features in a device.
- If the value Off is selected, all Worry Free WiFi features will be turned off (disabled).
- If the value On is selected, all Worry Free WiFi features will be turned on (enabled), but may or may not be usable, depending on other configuration performed.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Global Settings
Use this Sub-group to configure Existing Password, Password Value, Temporary Password Allow, Temporary Password Duration, Temporary Password Value, and device user Control.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiGlobalSettings
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Existing Password
Enter the Existing Password to enabling changing that Password.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiExistingPassword
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Password Value
Enter the Password Value required by the device user to access the in-device UI for configuring Worry Free WiFi features in a device.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiPassword
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Temporary Password Allow
Select whether a Temporary Password feature will be Allowed or Disallowed.
- If the value Disallow is selected, the Temporary Password feature will NOT be Allowed and you do not need to specify any additional information.
- If the value Allow is selected, the Temporary Password feature WILL be Allowed and you must also specify Temporary Password Duration and Temporary Password Duration to provide the Temporary Password Value and the Duration for which the Temporary Password Feature may be used.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiTemporaryPasswordState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 0 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Temporary Password Duration
Enter a duration in hours after which a Temporary Password expires and must be replaced with a new one.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiTemporaryPasswordDuration
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
Temporary Password Value
Enter a Temporary Password that can be shared with a device user to provide temporary and limited access to configure Worry Free WiFi to collect packets and encrypt those packets without having to share the full administrative password (which provides full access and never expires).
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiTemporaryPassword
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.2.
device user Control
Select whether the device user can access in-device UI for configuring Worry Free WiFi features in a device.
- If the value Disallow is selected, the device user will NOT be allowed to access in-device UI for configuring Worry Free WiFi features, even if they can enter the Password configured via Password Value.
- If the value Allow is selected, the device user will be allowed to access in-device UI for configuring Worry Free WiFi features, if they can enter the Password configured via Password Value.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiDeviceUserControl
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Disallow | 0 |
Allow | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Analysis Type
Select the Analysis Type that will be used by the Worry Free WiFi features in a device.
- If the value Roam is selected, Worry Free WiFi will perform analysis designed to troubleshoot and optimize WiFi operations related to roaming.
- If the value Voice is selected, then Worry Free WiFi will perform analysis designed to troubleshoot and optimize WiFi operations related to voice communications.
- If the value Connection is selected, then Worry Free WiFi will perform analysis designed to troubleshoot and optimize WiFi operations related to establishing connections.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiAnalysisType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Roam | 0 |
Voice | 1 |
Connection | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Roam/Voice Duration
Enter the Duration that an Analysis Session will run when the value Start is selected for Action and the value Roam or Voice is selected for Analysis Type. The value entered must be of the format HH:MM:SS, where HH is the integral number of hours, MM is the integral number of minutes, and SS is the integral number of seconds.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiAnalysisTypeRoamVoiceAnalysisDuration
Type = string
Support Information:
- NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Voice Packet Filtering Rule
Enter the Filtering Rule that will limits the capture of Session data to a specific voice packet type when the value Start is selected for Action and the value Voice is selected for Analysis Type. TBD.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiAnalysisTypeVoicePacketFilteringRule
Type = string
Support Information:
- NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Action
Select an Action to perform Worry Free WiFi features in a device.
- If the value Start is selected, a Worry Free WiFi Analysis Session will be started, terminating any Worry Free WiFi Analysis Session that was previously in progress. You may also need to be specify some or all of the following:
- Start Server Analytics to specify whether Server Analytics should be performed for the Analysis Session.
- Start Analysis Mode to specify the Activity Mode for the Analysis Session.
- Start Analysis SSID to specify the network for the Analysis Session.
- Start Session Name to specify the name for the Analysis Session.
- Start Logger Report Level to specify the Logger Report Level for the Analysis Session.
- Start Ping Type to specify the Ping Type for the Analysis Session.
- Start Remote Gateway Type to specify the Remote Gateway Type for the Analysis Session.
- Custom Server Address to specify the Custom Server Address for the Analysis Session.
- Start SD Card Storage to specify how SD Card Storage will be used for the Analysis Session.
- If the value Stop is selected, any Worry Free WiFi Analysis Session that is in progress will be terminated.
- If the value Clear is selected, any data accumulated from a Worry Free WiFi Analysis Session will be discarded.
- If the value Export is selected, the current Worry Free WiFi configuration will be exported and stored in a file in the device file system.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Start | 0 |
Stop | 1 |
Clear | 2 |
Export | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Start Server Analytics
Select whether Server Analytics should be performed during an Analysis Session started for the Worry Free WiFi feature when the value Start is selected for Action.
- If the value Turn Off is selected, Server Analytics will NOT be performed during the Analysis Session that is started.
- If the value Turn On is selected, Server Analytics will be performed during the Analysis Session that is started.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiActionStartServerAnalytics
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Turn Off | 0 |
Turn On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Start Analysis Mode
Select the Analysis Mode for an Analysis Session started for the Worry Free WiFi feature when the value Start is selected for Action.
- If the value Active is selected, Active Analysis will be performed during the Analysis Session that is started.
- If the value Passive is selected, Passive Analysis will be performed during the Analysis Session that is started.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiActionStartActivityMode
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Active | 0 |
Passive | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Start Analysis SSID
Enter the network that will be used for an Analysis Session started for the Worry Free WiFi feature when the value Start is selected for Action.
Note that if an Analysis Session is started for a network other than the currently configured network, the currently connected network will be disconnected so the specified network can be connected for use by the Analysis Session.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiActionStartAnalysisSSID
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Start Session Name
Enter the name of the Analysis Session to be started for the Worry Free WiFi feature when the value Start is selected for Action.
The name assigned to an Analysis Session can help to analyze exported data by identifying the Analysis Session during which the data was collected.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiActionStartSessionName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Start Logger Report Level
Select the Logger Report Level for an Analysis Session started for the Worry Free WiFi feature when the value Start is selected for Action.
- If the value Info is selected, all available data will be logged, including data that is informational as well as data related to warnings or errors that are detected.
- If the value Warning is selected, only data that is related to warnings or errors that are detected will be logged.
- If the value Error is selected, only data that is related to errors that are detected will be logged.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiActionStartLoggerReportLevel
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Info | 0 |
Warning | 1 |
Error | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Start Ping Type
Select the Ping Type for an Analysis Session started for the Worry Free WiFi feature when the value Start is selected for Action.
- If the value No Data is selected, Pings sent during the Analysis Session that is started will include no data.
- If the value Data Ping is selected, Pings sent during the Analysis Session that is started will include data.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiActionStartPingType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
No Data | 0 |
Data Ping | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Start Remote Gateway Type
Select the Type of Remote Gateway for an Analysis Session started for the Worry Free WiFi feature when the value Start is selected for Action.
- If the value Default is selected, the Default Remote Gateway will be used.
- If the value Custom is selected, a custom Remote Gateway will be used and you must also specify Custom Server Address to provide the desired custom Gateway Server Address.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiActionStartRemoteGatewayType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Default | 0 |
Custom | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Custom Server Address
Enter the Custom Remote Gateway Server Address for an Analysis Session started for the Worry Free WiFi feature when the value Start is selected for Action and if the value Custom is selected for Start Remote Gateway Type.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiActionStartRemoteGatewayTypeCustomServerAddress
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Start SD Card Storage
Select how SD Card Storage will be used for an Analysis Session started for the Worry Free WiFi feature when the value Start is selected for Action.
- If the value Only Live Data is selected, only the most recent data from the new Analysis Session will be stored in the SD Card and will replace any prior Analysis Session data stored.
- If the value Delete old Ping and Packet Data is selected, old Ping and Packet Data will be deleted and replaced by any new Ping and Packet Data for the new Analysis Session.
- Deprecated: If the value Delete Old Sessions(Deprecated) is selected, any data generated by any prior Analysis Sessions will be deleted and replace by the data from the newAnalysis Session.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiActionStartSdCardStorage
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Only Live Data | 0 |
Delete old Ping and Packet Data | 1 |
Delete Old Sessions(Deprecated) | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Start Session Storage Duration
Enter the maximum Duration of Session data to be captured and Stored during Server Analytics performed during a Session started for the Worry Free WiFi feature when the value Start is selected for Action and the value Delete old Ping and Packet Data is selected for Start SD Card Storage. The value entered must be of the format HH:MM:SS, where HH is the integral number of hours, MM is the integral number of minutes, and SS is the integral number of seconds.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiActionStartSessionStorageDuration
Type = string
Support Information:
- NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Packet Capture
Use this Sub-group to configure State, On File Name, On Max File Size, On Max Storage Size, and Type.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiPacketCapture
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
State
Select whether Packet Capture will be performed by the Worry Free WiFi feature in a device.
- If the value Off is selected, the Packet Capture will NOT be performed. This can significantly decrease the load on the device and decrease battery drain, but will provide less data that can be used for troubleshooting.
- If the value On is selected, the Packet Capture WILL be performed. This can significantly increase the load on the device and increase battery drain, but will provide additional data that can be used for troubleshooting.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiPacketCaptureState
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
On File Name
Enter the file name of the file into which Packet Capture data will be stored by the Worry Free WiFi feature in a device when the value On is selected for State.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiPacketCaptureStateOnFileName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
On Max File Size
Enter the maximum size of the file into which Packet Capture data (in megabytes) will be stored by the Worry Free WiFi feature in a device when the value On is selected for State.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiPacketCaptureStateOnMaxFileSize
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
On Max Storage Size
Enter the maximum amount of Packet Capture data (in megabytes) that will be stored by the Worry Free WiFi feature in a device when the value On is selected for State.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiPacketCaptureStateOnMaxStorageSize
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 8.3.
Type
Select the Package Capture Type that will be control the type of Packets that will be captured by the Worry Free WiFi features in a device when State is used to enable Packet Capture.
- If the value Management Only is selected, Worry Free WiFi will only capture Management Packets.
- If the value All is selected, Worry Free WiFi will capture ALL Packets, including Packets that might contain sensitive data.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiPacketCaptureType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Management Only | 1 |
All | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Coverage View
Use this Sub-group to configure Scan Feature Type, Action, Start Scan Interval, Start SSID, Start Auto Reachability Test, Start Server Analytics, Start Session Name, and Start SD Card Storage.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiCoverageView
Type = bundle
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Scan Feature Type
Select the Scan Feature Type that will control the type of Scanning that will be performed by Worry Free WiFi as part of Coverage View in a device.
- If the value Coverage View is selected, Worry Free WiFi will perform full scanning as required to support Coverage View.
- If the value Scan is selected, then Worry Free WiFi will perform more limited scanning.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiScanFeatureType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Coverage View | 1 |
Scan | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Action
Select an Action to perform for Coverage View.
If the value Start is selected, a Worry Free WiFi Analysis Session will be started, terminating any Worry Free WiFi Analysis Session that was previously in progress. You may also need to specify some or all of the following:
Start Scan Interval to specify the Scan Interval to use for Coverage View.
Start SSID to specify the SSID to use for Coverage View.
Start Auto Reachability Test to specify whether an Auto Reachability Test should be performed as part of Coverage View.
Start Auto Reachability Test to specify whether Server Analytics should be performed as part of Coverage View.
Start Session Name to specify the Session Name to use for Coverage View.
- Start Session Name to specify whether SD Card Storage will be used for Coverage View.
If the value Stop is selected, any Worry Free WiFi Analysis Session that is in progress will be terminated.
If the value Clear is selected, any data accumulated from a Worry Free WiFi Analysis Session will be discarded.
If the value Export is selected, the current Worry Free WiFi configuration will be exported and stored in a file in the device file system.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiCoverageViewAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Start | 0 |
Stop | 1 |
Clear | 2 |
Export | 3 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Start Scan Interval
Enter the Scan Interval to be used for Coverage View.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiCoverageViewActionStartScanInterval
Type = integer
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Start SSID
Enter the SSID that identifies the network to be used for Coverage View.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiCoverageViewActionStartSsid
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Start Auto Reachability Test
Select whether an Auto Reachability Test should be performed as part of Coverage View.
- If the value Off is selected, then Worry Free WiFi will NOT perform an Auto Reachability Test as part of Coverage View each time a Roam occurs.
- If the value On is selected, Worry Free WiFi will perform an Auto Reachability Test as part of Coverage View each time a Roam occurs.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiCoverageViewActionStartAutoReachabilityTest
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Start Server Analytics
Select whether Server Analytics should be performed by Worry Free WiFi as part of Coverage View when the value Start is selected for Action.
- If the value Off is selected, Worry Free WiFi will NOT perform Server Analytics as part of Coverage View.
- If the value On is selected, Worry Free WiFi will perform Server Analytics as part of Coverage View.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiCoverageViewActionStartServerAnalytics
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Off | 0 |
On | 1 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Start Session Name
Enter a Session Name that should be used by Worry Free WiFi as part of Coverage View when the value Start is selected for Action.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiCoverageViewActionStartSessionName
Type = string
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Start SD Card Storage
Select how SD Card Storage is used for an Analysis Session started as part of Coverage View for the Worry Free WiFi feature when the value Start is selected for Action.
- If the value Only Live Data is selected, only the most recent data from the new Analysis Session will be stored in the SD Card and will replace any prior Analysis Session data stored.
- If the value Delete old Ping and Packet Data is selected, old Ping and Packet Data will be deleted and replaced by any new Ping and Packet Data for the new Analysis Session.
- Deprecated: If the value Delete old Sessions(Deprecated) is selected, any data generated by any prior Analysis Sessions will be deleted and replace by the data from the newAnalysis Session.
Detail Information:
Key = wfWiFiCoverageViewActionStartSdCardStorage
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Only Live Data | 0 |
Delete old Ping and Packet Data | 1 |
Delete old Sessions(Deprecated) | 2 |
Support Information:
NOT supported on Device(s): TC20 and TC25.
Supported from: MX 9.1.
Zebra Licensing Configuration
Use this Sub-group to configure License Action, Activate License Method, From Server AID Value, From Server Standard Class, Partition Name, From Server Custom Class, From Server Custom URL, Zebra License Persistence, From Server Custom Friendly Name, From Local File Path and Name, From Local File Source Server Class, Return License Server Type, Friendly Name, Return License AID Value, Return All Licenses Server Type, Friendly Name, Refresh License AID Value, and Delete Server Friendly Name.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseStep
Type = bundle
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
License Action
Select an Action to manage Zebra-issued licenses on a device.
- If the value Activate License is selected, a license will be activated, making it usable on the device. You must also specify Activate License Method, From Server AID Value, From Server Standard Class, From Server Custom Class, From Server Custom URL, From Server Custom Friendly Name, From Local File Path and Name, and From Local File Source Server Class to define the license to be activated and how that license should be activated.
- If the value Return License is selected, a previously activated license will be returned, allowing it to be re-allocated for use on another device. You must also specify Return License Server Type, Friendly Name, and Return License AID Value to define the license to be returned and how that license should be returned.
- If the value Return All Licenses is selected, all licenses previously activated from a given License Server will be returned, allowing them to be re-allocated for use on other devices. You must also specify Return All Licenses Server Type and Friendly Name to define how the licenses were acquired and therefore to identify which licenses should be returned and how they should be returned.
- If the value Refresh License is selected, a previously activated license will be refreshed, updating anything that may have changed, such as its expiration date, capabilities, etc. You must also specify Refresh License AID Value to provide the license to be refreshed.
- If the value Delete Server is selected, a previously defined Custom Server, along with all licenses allocated via that Custom Server, will be deleted. You must also specify Delete Server Friendly Name to provide the Friendly Name that identifies the Custom Server to be deleted.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseAction
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Activate License | Activate |
Return License | Return |
Return All Licenses | Reset |
Refresh License | Refresh |
Delete Server | DeleteLicenseSource |
Activate Feature | activatefeature |
Refresh Feature | refreshfeature |
Return Feature | returnfeature |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Activate License Method
Select the method that should be used to activate a Zebra-issued license a device when the value Activate License is selected for License Action.
- If the value From Server Standard is selected, the license will be activated from a Standard Server and you must also specify From Server Standard Class to provide the class of Standard Server via which the license will be activated and you must also specify From Server AID Value to identify the license to be activated.
- If the value From Server Custom is chose, the license will be activated from a Custom Server and you must also specify From Server Custom Class to provide the class of Custom Server via which the license will be activated and you must also specify From Server AID Value to identify the license to be activated. You may also specify From Server Custom URL depending on the value selected for From Server Custom Class.
- If the value From Local File is selected, the license will be activated from a license file stored in the device file system and you must also specify From Local File Path and Name and From Local File Source Server Class to provide the license file and the class of Server from which the license file was acquired.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionActivateLicenseMethod
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
From Server Standard | 1 |
From Server Custom | 2 |
From Local File | 3 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
From Server AID Value
Enter the Activation Identifier (AID) that identifies a Zebra-issued license to be activated on a device when the value Activate License is selected for License Action.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionActivateLicenseMethodFromServerAidValue
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
From Server Standard Class
Select the Class of Standard Server via which a Zebra-issued license will be activated on a device when the value Activate License is selected for License Action and the value From Server Standard is selected for Activate License Method.
- If the value Production Cloud Direct is selected, the license will be activated by communicating directly to a Production Zebra License Server at a fixed known location on the Internet. The Production Server should be used when deploying licenses to devices for production use.
- If the value Test Cloud Direct is selected, the license will be activated by communicating directly to a Test Zebra License Server at a fixed known location on the Internet. The Test Server should be used when tested the deployment of licenses to devices to avoid consuming actual production licenses.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionActivateLicenseMethodFromServerStandardClass
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Production Cloud Direct | 1 |
Test Cloud Direct | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
Partition Name
Enter the name of the partition on the local server from which to pull a license. Leave blank to pull from a non-partitioned license pool
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionPartitionName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 11.2.
From Server Custom Class
Select the Class of Custom Server via which a Zebra-issued license will be activated on a device when the value Activate License is selected for License Action and the value From Server Custom is selected for Activate License Method.
- If the value Production Cloud Proxy is selected, the license will be activated by communicating to a Production Zebra License Server at a fixed known location on the Internet via a Local Proxy Server. You must also specify From Server Custom URL to provide the Local Proxy Server to be used.
- If the value Test Cloud Proxy is selected, the license will be activated by communicating to a Test Zebra License Server at a fixed known location on the Internet via a Local Proxy Server. You must also specify From Server Custom URL to provide the Local Proxy Server to be used.
- If the value Local Direct is selected, the license will be activated by communicating to a Local License Server. You must also specify From Server Custom URL to provide the Local License Server to be used.
- If the value Other is selected, the license will be activated by communicating to some other Server. You must also specify From Server Custom URL to provide the Server to be used.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionActivateLicenseMethodFromServerCustomClass
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Production Cloud Proxy | 1 |
Test Cloud Proxy | 2 |
Local Direct | 3 |
Other | 4 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
From Server Custom URL
Enter the URL of a Custom Server via which a Zebra-issued license will be activated on a device when the value Activate License is selected for License Action and the value From Server Custom is selected for Activate License Method.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionActivateLicenseMethodFromServerCustomUrl
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
Zebra License Persistence
Select whether all licenses should persist on-device.
- If the value Turn On is selected, licenses will be stored on-device to be re-applied after an Enterprise Reset. - If the value Turn Off is selected, licenses will NOT be stored on-device. Any license that was previously stored will be deleted.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicensePersistence
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Turn On | 1 |
Turn Off | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 11.2.
From Server Custom Friendly Name
Enter a Friendly Name for a Custom Server via which a Zebra-issued license will be activated on a device when the value Activate License is selected for License Action and the value From Server Custom is selected for Activate License Method.
A Friendly Name is kept for each Custom Server used to acquire licenses and is used when later operating on such licenses to identify the Custom Server via which a license was acquired and hence via which it must be refreshed, returned, etc. The Friendly Name is also used to identify a Custom Server to be deleted.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionActivateLicenseMethodFromServerCustomFriendlyName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
From Local File Path and Name
Enter the local path and file name of a license file in the device file system from a which a Zebra-issued license will be activated on a device when the value Activate License is selected for License Action and the value From Local File is selected for Activate License Method. You must also specify From Local File Source Server Class to identify the class of Server from which the license file was acquired, which could impact how it is processed.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionActivateLicenseMethodFromLocalFilePathAndName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
From Local File Source Server Class
Select the class of Server from which the license file to be activated was acquired when the value Activate License is selected for License Action and when the value From Local File is selected for Activate License Method and when From Local File Path and Name is specified.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionActivateLicenseMethodFromLocalFileSourceServerClass
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Production Cloud | 1 |
Test Cloud | 2 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
Return License Server Type
Select the Type of Standard Server via which a Zebra-issued license was activated on a device and therefore via which it should be returned, when the value Return License is selected for License Action.
- If the value Production Cloud Direct is selected, the license will be assumed to have been activated by by communicating directly to a Production Zebra License Server at a fixed known location on the Internet and the license will be returned by communicating directly to the same server in the same way.
- If the value Test Cloud Direct is selected, the license will be assumed to have been activated by by communicating directly to a Test Zebra License Server at a fixed known location on the Internet and the license will be returned by communicating directly to the same server in the same way.
- If the value Server Friendly Name is selected, the license will be assumed to have been activated by by communicating to a Custom Server. You must also specify Friendly Name to provide the Friendly Name that identifies the Custom Server via which the license was acquired and hence via which it should be returned.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionReturnLicenseServerType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Production Cloud Direct | 1 |
Test Cloud Direct | 2 |
Server Friendly Name | 3 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Friendly Name
Enter the Friendly Name that identifies the Custom Server via which a Zebra-issued license was activated on a device and therefore via which it should be returned, when the value Return License is selected for License Action and the value Server Friendly Name was selected for Return License Server Type.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionReturnLicenseServerTypeFriendlyName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Return License AID Value
Enter the Activation Identifier (AID) that identifies a Zebra-issued license to be returned on a device when the value Return License is selected for License Action.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionReturnLicenseAidValue
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Return All Licenses Server Type
Select the Type of Standard Server via which a set of Zebra-issued licenses was activated on a device and therefore via which they should be returned, when the value Return All Licenses is selected for License Action.
- If the value Production Cloud Direct is selected, the licenses will be assumed to have been activated by by communicating directly to a Production Zebra License Server at a fixed known location on the Internet and all such licenses will be returned by communicating directly to the same server in the same way.
- If the value Test Cloud Direct is selected, the licenses will be assumed to have been activated by by communicating directly to a Test Zebra License Server at a fixed known location on the Internet and all such licenses will be returned by communicating directly to the same server in the same way.
- If the value Server Friendly Name is selected, the licenses will be assumed to have been activated by by communicating to a Custom Server. You must also specify Friendly Name to provide the Friendly Name that identifies the Custom Server via which the licenses were acquired and hence via which all such licenses should be returned.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionReturnAllLicensesServerType
Type = string
UI Choice | JSON Value |
---|---|
Production Cloud Direct | 1 |
Test Cloud Direct | 2 |
Server Friendly Name | 3 |
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Friendly Name
Enter the Friendly Name that identifies the Custom Server via which a set of Zebra-issued licenses was activated on a device and therefore via which they should be returned, when the value Return All Licenses is selected for License Action and the value Server Friendly Name was selected for Return All Licenses Server Type.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionReturnAllLicensesServerTypeFriendlyName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.
Refresh License AID Value
Enter the Activation Identifier (AID) that identifies a Zebra-issued license to be refreshed on a device when the value Refresh License is selected for License Action.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionRefreshLicenseAidValue
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 7.1.
Delete Server Friendly Name
Enter the Friendly Name that identifies the Custom Server to be deleted, when the value Delete Server is selected for License Action.
Detail Information:
Key = zebraLicenseActionDeleteServerFriendlyName
Type = string
Support Information:
- Supported from: MX 8.1.